]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
*** empty log message ***
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 ---
117 ** The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el uses a different terminfo name.
118 The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el now uses "eterm-color" as its
119 terminfo name, since term.el now supports color.
120
121 ---
122 ** Emacs Lisp source files are compressed by default if `gzip' is available.
123
124 \f
125 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
126
127 +++
128 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
129 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
130 the fancy startup screen.
131
132 +++
133 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
134 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
135 the blinking cursor.
136
137 +++
138 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
139 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
140
141 +++
142 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
143 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
144 can start with this line:
145
146 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
147
148 +++
149 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
150 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
151 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
152
153 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
154
155 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
156 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
157
158 +++
159 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
160 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
161
162 +++
163 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
164 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
165 an interactively callable function.
166
167 +++
168 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
169 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
170 affects the initial frame.
171
172 +++
173 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
174 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
175 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
176 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
177 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
178
179 +++
180 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
181 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
182 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
183 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
184 `inhibit-splash-screen').
185
186 +++
187 ** The default is now to use a bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
188 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
189 the bitmap icon off.
190
191 +++
192 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
193 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
194 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
195
196 +++
197 ** Init file changes
198 If the init file ~/.emacs does not exist, Emacs will try
199 ~/.emacs.d/init.el or ~/.emacs.d/init.elc. You can also put the shell
200 init file .emacs_SHELL under ~/.emacs.d.
201
202 +++
203 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
204 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
205 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
206 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
207 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
208 \f
209 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
210
211 +++
212 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
213 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
214 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
215 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
216
217 +++
218 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
219 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
220
221 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
222 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
223
224 +++
225 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
226 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
227 the operating system or your X server.
228
229 +++
230 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
231
232 +++
233 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
234 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
235 you about it.
236
237 +++
238 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
239 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
240
241 +++
242 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
243 previous mark if you set `set-mark-command-repeat-pop' to t. I.e. C-u
244 C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC
245 to set the mark immediately after a jump.
246
247 +++
248 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
249 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
250
251 +++
252 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
253
254 See below under "incremental search changes".
255
256 ---
257 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
258
259 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
260 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
261 directory with Dired.
262
263 You can get the old behavior by typing C-x C-f M-n RET, which fetches
264 the actual file name into the minibuffer.
265
266 +++
267 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
268 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
269 it remains unchanged.
270
271 +++
272 ** When Emacs prompts for file names, SPC no longer completes the file name.
273 This is so filenames with embedded spaces could be input without the
274 need to quote the space with a C-q. The underlying changes in the
275 keymaps that are active in the minibuffer are described below under
276 "New keymaps for typing file names".
277
278 +++
279 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
280 M-o M-o requests refontification.
281
282 +++
283 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
284
285 See below for more details.
286
287 +++
288 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
289 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
290 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
291 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
292 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
293 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
294 \f
295 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
296
297 +++
298 ** !MEM FULL! at the start of the mode line indicates that Emacs
299 cannot get any more memory for Lisp data. This often means it could
300 crash soon if you do things that use more memory. On most systems,
301 killing buffers will get out of this state. If killing buffers does
302 not make !MEM FULL! disappear, you should save your work and start
303 a new Emacs.
304
305 +++
306 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
307 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
308
309 +++
310 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left
311 (previous-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and
312 C-x right can be used as well. The functions keep a different buffer
313 cycle for each frame, using the frame-local buffer list.
314
315 +++
316 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
317
318 +++
319 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
320 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
321
322 ---
323 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
324 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
325
326 +++
327 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
328 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
329
330 +++
331 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
332 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
333 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
334 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
335
336 +++
337 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
338 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
339 in Indented-Text mode.
340
341 +++
342 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
343
344 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
345 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
346 in the value, use `$$'.
347
348 +++
349 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
350 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
351 `same-window'.
352
353 +++
354 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
355 from the locale.
356
357 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
358 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
359 only faces matching this regexp.
360
361 ** Mark command changes:
362
363 +++
364 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
365 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
366 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
367
368 +++
369 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
370
371 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
372 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
373 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
374 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
375 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
376 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
377 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
378 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
379 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
380
381 +++
382 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
383
384 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
385 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
386 paragraphs.
387
388 +++
389 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
390 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
391 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
392 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
393 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
394 command only.
395
396 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
397 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
398 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
399 mark or the region.
400
401 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
402 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
403 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
404 C-g.
405
406 +++
407 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
408 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
409 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
410
411 ** Help command changes:
412
413 +++
414 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
415
416 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
417
418 C-h d runs apropos-documentation.
419
420 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
421 that do not change:
422
423 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
424 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
425
426 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
427 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
428
429 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
430 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
431 run by the key sequence.
432 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
433 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
434 that command.
435
436 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
437 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
438 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
439 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
440 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
441 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
442 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
443 new-kill-line is on C-k
444
445 ---
446 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
447 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
448 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
449 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
450
451 +++
452 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
453 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
454
455 +++
456 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
457 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
458 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
459 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
460 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
461 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
462 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node'). In
463 addition, it now makes hyperlinks to URLs as well if the URL is
464 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `URL'.
465
466 +++
467 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
468 description various information about a character, including its
469 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
470 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
471 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
472
473 +++
474 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
475 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
476
477 +++
478 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
479 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
480 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
481 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
482 keyboard oriented alternative.
483
484 +++
485 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
486 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
487 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
488 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
489 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
490
491 +++
492 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
493 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
494 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
495 available.
496
497 +++
498 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
499 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
500 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
501 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
502 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
503 matching item.
504
505 ** Incremental Search changes:
506
507 +++
508 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
509 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
510 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
511 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
512 for details.
513
514 +++
515 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
516 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
517 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
518 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
519
520 +++
521 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
522 at the end of a line.
523
524 +++
525 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
526 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
527 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
528
529 +++
530 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
531 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
532 search string used as the string to replace.
533
534 +++
535 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
536 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
537 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
538
539 ** Replace command changes:
540
541 ---
542 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
543 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
544 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
545
546 +++
547 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
548 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
549 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
550 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
551 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
552 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
553 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
554 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
555 can be edited for each replacement.
556
557 +++
558 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
559 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
560
561 ---
562 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
563 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
564
565 ** File operation changes:
566
567 +++
568 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
569 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
570 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
571 is only rarely needed.
572
573 +++
574 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
575 suffix from every line before processing all the lines.
576
577 +++
578 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
579 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
580
581 +++
582 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
583 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
584
585 +++
586 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
587
588 ---
589 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
590
591 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
592 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
593 directory with Dired.
594
595 +++
596 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
597 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
598 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
599 file.)
600
601 +++
602 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
603 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
604
605 +++
606 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
607 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
608 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
609 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
610 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
611 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
612
613 ---
614 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
615 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
616 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
617
618 ---
619 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
620 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
621 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
622
623 +++
624 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
625 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
626 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
627 in data loss, use with care.
628
629 +++
630 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
631 Emacs asks for confirmation.
632
633 +++
634 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
635
636 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
637 when visiting the file.
638
639 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
640 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
641 when saving the file.
642
643 +++
644 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
645 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
646 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
647 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
648 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
649 modes do.
650
651 ** Minibuffer changes:
652
653 +++
654 *** The new file-name-shadow-mode is turned ON by default, so that when
655 entering a file name, any prefix which Emacs will ignore is dimmed.
656
657 +++
658 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
659 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
660 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
661 prompt string.
662
663 ---
664 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
665
666 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
667 have in common and where they begin to differ.
668
669 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
670 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
671 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
672 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
673 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
674 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
675 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
676 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
677
678 Above fontification is always done when listing completions is
679 triggered at minibuffer. If you want to fontify completions whose
680 listing is triggered at the other normal buffer, you have to pass
681 the common prefix of completions to `display-completion-list' as
682 its second argument.
683
684 +++
685 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
686 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
687 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
688 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
689 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
690 candidate is a directory.
691
692 +++
693 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
694 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
695 it remains unchanged.
696
697 +++
698 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
699 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
700 elements are deleted.
701
702 ** Redisplay changes:
703
704 +++
705 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
706 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
707 appears between the position information and the major mode.
708
709 +++
710 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
711
712 +++
713 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
714 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
715 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
716
717 +++
718 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
719 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
720 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
721 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
722
723 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
724 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
725 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
726 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
727 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
728 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
729
730 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
731 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
732
733 ---
734 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller than
735 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
736 vscroll property.
737
738 +++
739 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
740 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
741 the mode line of the currently selected window.
742
743 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
744 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
745
746 +++
747 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
748 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
749 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
750 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
751 set-fringe-style.
752
753 +++
754 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
755 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
756 the window can be scrolled.
757
758 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
759 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
760 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
761
762 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
763 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
764
765 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
766 position of each bitmap individually.
767
768 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
769 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
770 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
771 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
772
773 +++
774 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
775 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
776 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
777 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
778 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
779
780 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
781 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
782
783 +++
784 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
785 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
786 outside those margins.
787
788 +++
789 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
790 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
791
792 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
793 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
794 or when the frame is resized.
795
796 ** Cursor display changes:
797
798 +++
799 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
800 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
801
802 +++
803 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
804
805 +++
806 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
807 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
808 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
809 cursor does.
810
811 +++
812 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
813 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
814 appears in.
815
816 +++
817 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
818 of the recognized cursor types.
819
820 +++
821 *** On text terminals, the variable `visible-cursor' controls whether Emacs
822 uses the "very visible" cursor (the default) or the normal cursor.
823
824 ** New faces:
825
826 +++
827 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
828 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
829 areas.
830
831 *** `mode-line-buffer-id' is the standard face for buffer identification
832 parts of the mode line.
833
834 +++
835 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
836 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
837 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
838 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
839 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
840 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
841
842 +++
843 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
844
845 ** Font-Lock changes:
846
847 +++
848 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
849 M-o M-o requests refontification.
850
851 +++
852 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
853 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
854 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
855
856 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
857 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
858 `Info-mode-hook'.
859
860 +++
861 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
862 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
863 The default value is 1.
864
865 +++
866 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
867 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
868 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
869 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
870 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
871
872 +++
873 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
874
875 +++
876 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
877
878 +++
879 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
880 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
881 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
882 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
883
884 ---
885 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
886 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
887 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
888 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
889 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
890
891 ---
892 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
893
894 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
895 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
896 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
897 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
898
899 ---
900 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
901
902 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
903 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
904 refontification takes place.
905
906 ** Menu support:
907
908 ---
909 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
910 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
911 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
912 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
913 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
914 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
915
916 ---
917 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
918
919 ---
920 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
921
922 ---
923 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
924 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
925 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
926
927 +++
928 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
929 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
930
931 ---
932 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
933 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
934
935 +++
936 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
937 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
938 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
939
940 ---
941 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
942 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
943
944 +++
945 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
946 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
947 the new dialog.
948
949 ** Mouse changes:
950
951 +++
952 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
953 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
954 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
955 can be selected only when it is active.
956
957 +++
958 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
959 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
960 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
961 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
962 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
963 to give it focus.
964
965 +++
966 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
967
968 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
969 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
970 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
971 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
972 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
973 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
974
975 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
976 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
977 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
978 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
979 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
980 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
981 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
982 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
983 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
984
985 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
986 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
987 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
988 you release it).
989
990 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
991 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
992
993 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
994 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
995
996 +++
997 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
998 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
999 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1000 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1001 also disable mouse highlighting.
1002
1003 +++
1004 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1005 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1006 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1007
1008 ---
1009 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1010 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1011
1012 ---
1013 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1014
1015 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1016 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1017 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1018 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1019
1020 +++
1021 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1022
1023 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1024
1025 ---
1026 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1027 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1028 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1029 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1030 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1031
1032 +++
1033 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1034 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1035 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1036 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1037 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1038 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1039 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1040 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1041
1042 +++
1043 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1044 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1045
1046 +++
1047 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1048 coding system.
1049
1050 +++
1051 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1052 of a file.
1053
1054 ---
1055 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1056 unicode.
1057
1058 +++
1059 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1060 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1061 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1062 command.
1063
1064 +++
1065 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1066 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1067
1068 +++
1069 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1070 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1071 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1072 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1073 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1074 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1075 mule-unicode-... ones.
1076
1077 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1078 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1079 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1080 possible.
1081
1082 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1083 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1084 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1085 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1086 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1087
1088 ---
1089 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1090 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1091 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1092 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1093
1094 ---
1095 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1096 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1097 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1098 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1099 automatically according to the locale.)
1100
1101 ---
1102 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1103 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1104 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1105 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1106 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1107 tamil-inscript.
1108
1109 ---
1110 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1111 characters.
1112
1113 ---
1114 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1115 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1116 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1117 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1118 M-f (forward-word)
1119 M-b (backward-word)
1120 M-d (kill-word)
1121 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1122 M-t (transpose-words)
1123 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1124
1125 ---
1126 *** Indian support has been updated.
1127 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1128 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1129 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1130 supported.
1131
1132 ---
1133 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1134
1135 ---
1136 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1137 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1138 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1139 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1140 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1141 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1142 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1143 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1144 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1145 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1146 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1147 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1148
1149 ---
1150 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1151 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1152 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1153
1154 ---
1155 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1156 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1157 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1158 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1159 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1160
1161 ---
1162 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1163 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1164
1165 ---
1166 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1167 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1168 fontset appropriately.
1169
1170 ** Customize changes:
1171
1172 +++
1173 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1174 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1175 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1176 enable-theme to renable a disabled theme.
1177
1178 +++
1179 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1180 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1181 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1182 faces.
1183
1184 ---
1185 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1186 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1187 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1188 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1189 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1190 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1191 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1192
1193 +++
1194 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1195 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1196 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1197 under the "[State]" button.
1198
1199 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1200
1201 +++
1202 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1203 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to T in Buffer Menu
1204 mode.
1205
1206 +++
1207 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1208 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1209 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1210
1211 ---
1212 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1213 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1214 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1215
1216 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1217 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1218 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1219 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1220 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1221
1222 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1223 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1224 t, and the status is shown.
1225
1226 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1227 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1228
1229 ** Dired mode:
1230
1231 ---
1232 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1233 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1234 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1235
1236 +++
1237 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1238 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1239
1240 +++
1241 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1242 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1243
1244 +++
1245 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1246 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1247 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1248 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1249 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1250 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1251
1252 +++
1253 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1254 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1255
1256 +++
1257 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1258
1259 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1260 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1261 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1262 instead.
1263
1264 +++
1265 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1266 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1267 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1268 directory listing into a buffer.
1269
1270 ** Comint changes:
1271
1272 ---
1273 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1274 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1275 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1276 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1277 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1278
1279 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1280 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1281
1282 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1283 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1284 lines, including any prompts.
1285
1286 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1287 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1288 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1289 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1290 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1291 `kill-region' if read-only properties are involved: it copies the text
1292 to the kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1293
1294 +++
1295 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1296 modes (shell-mode, etc.) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1297 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1298 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1299
1300 +++
1301 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1302 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1303 but declared obsolete.
1304
1305 ** M-x Compile changes:
1306
1307 ---
1308 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1309
1310 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1311 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1312 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1313 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1314
1315 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1316 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1317 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1318
1319 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1320 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1321 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1322 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1323 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1324
1325 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1326
1327 +++
1328 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1329 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1330 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1331 subprocesses inherit.
1332
1333 +++
1334 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1335 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1336
1337 +++
1338 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1339 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1340 in new face `next-error'.
1341
1342 +++
1343 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1344 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1345 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1346 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1347 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1348 C-c C-f.
1349
1350 +++
1351 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1352 the compilation buffer.
1353
1354 +++
1355 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1356 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1357 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1358 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1359 of the window.
1360
1361 ** Occur mode changes:
1362
1363 +++
1364 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1365 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1366 switching to it.
1367
1368 +++
1369 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1370 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1371
1372 +++
1373 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1374 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1375 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1376 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1377 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1378
1379 ** Grep changes:
1380
1381 +++
1382 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1383
1384 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1385 customization group.
1386
1387 ---
1388 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1389
1390 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1391 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1392
1393 +++
1394 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1395 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1396
1397 ---
1398 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1399 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1400 settings, for grep commands only.
1401
1402 +++
1403 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1404 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1405 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1406 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1407 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1408 source line is highlighted.
1409
1410 +++
1411 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1412 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1413 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1414 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1415 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1416 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1417 file.
1418
1419 +++
1420 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1421 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1422 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1423 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1424 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1425 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1426
1427 ** X Windows Support:
1428
1429 +++
1430 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1431 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1432 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1433
1434 +++
1435 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1436 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1437 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1438 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1439 Meta and Alt:
1440 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1441 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1442
1443 +++
1444 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1445 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1446
1447 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1448 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1449
1450 ---
1451 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1452 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1453 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1454 and use the more appropriately result.
1455
1456 ---
1457 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1458 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1459 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1460
1461 ** Xterm support:
1462
1463 ---
1464 *** If you enable Xterm Mouse mode, Emacs will respond to mouse clicks
1465 on the mode line, header line and display margin, when run in an xterm.
1466
1467 ---
1468 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1469 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1470 following should work:
1471 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1472 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1473 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1474
1475 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1476
1477 +++
1478 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1479 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1480 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1481 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1482 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1483 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1484 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1485 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1486 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1487
1488 ---
1489 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1490 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1491 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1492 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1493 all of these colors.
1494
1495 +++
1496 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1497 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1498 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1499 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1500 colors as on X.
1501
1502 ---
1503 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1504 \f
1505 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1506
1507 ** Rcirc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1508
1509 Rcirc is an Internet relay chat (IRC) client. It supports
1510 simultaneous connections to multiple IRC servers. Each discussion
1511 takes place in its own buffer. For each connection you can join
1512 several channels (many-to-many) and participate in private
1513 (one-to-one) chats. Both channel and private chats are contained in
1514 separate buffers.
1515
1516 To start an IRC session, type M-x irc, and follow the prompts for
1517 server, port, nick and initial channels.
1518
1519 ---
1520 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1521
1522 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1523 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1524 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1525 separate manual.
1526
1527 +++
1528 ** savehist saves minibuffer histories between sessions.
1529 To use this feature, turn on savehist-mode in your `.emacs' file.
1530
1531 +++
1532 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1533 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1534 program files that include other program files.
1535
1536 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1537 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1538 in them.
1539
1540 +++
1541 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1542
1543 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1544 Emacs Lisp. The prefix for Calc has been changed to `C-x *' and Calc
1545 can be started with `C-x * *'. The Calc manual is separate from the
1546 Emacs manual; within Emacs, type "C-h i m calc RET" to read the
1547 manual. A reference card is available in `etc/calccard.tex' and
1548 `etc/calccard.ps'.
1549
1550 ---
1551 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1552 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1553
1554 ---
1555 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1556
1557 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1558 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1559 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1560 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1561
1562 +++
1563 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1564 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1565
1566 ---
1567 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1568
1569 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1570 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1571 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1572 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1573 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1574 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1575
1576 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1577 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1578 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1579 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1580
1581 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1582 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1583 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1584 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1585 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1586 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1587 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1588
1589 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1590 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1591 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1592
1593 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1594 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1595
1596 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1597 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1598 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1599 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1600
1601 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1602 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1603 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1604 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1605
1606 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1607 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1608 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1609 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1610
1611 +++
1612 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1613
1614 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1615 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1616 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1617 capabilities.
1618
1619 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1620 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1621
1622 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1623 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1624 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1625
1626 +++
1627 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1628 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1629 to increment the SOA serial.
1630
1631 ---
1632 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1633 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1634 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1635 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1636 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1637 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1638
1639 +++
1640 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1641 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1642
1643 +++
1644 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1645 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1646 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1647 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1648 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1649
1650 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1651 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1652 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1653 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1654 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1655 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1656
1657 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1658 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1659 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1660 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1661 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1662 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1663 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1664 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1665 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1666 or local keymaps.
1667
1668 +++
1669 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1670 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1671
1672 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1673 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1674 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1675 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1676
1677 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1678 defined macros.
1679
1680 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1681 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1682 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1683 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1684 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1685 for more commands.
1686
1687 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1688 the keyboard macro ring.
1689
1690 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1691 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1692
1693 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1694 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1695 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1696 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1697
1698 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1699 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1700 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1701
1702 ---
1703 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1704 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1705 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1706
1707 +++
1708 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1709 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1710
1711 +++
1712 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1713 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1714 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1715 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1716 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1717 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1718 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1719 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1720 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1721
1722 +++
1723 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1724
1725 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1726 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1727 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1728 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1729 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1730 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1731
1732 ---
1733 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1734 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1735 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1736 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1737
1738 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1739
1740 ---
1741 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1742 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1743 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1744 settings.
1745
1746 +++
1747 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1748 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1749 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1750 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1751
1752 +++
1753 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1754 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1755
1756 +++
1757 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1758 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1759 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1760 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1761 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1762 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1763
1764 ** The tumme.el package allows you to easily view, tag and in other ways
1765 manipulate image files and their thumbnails, using dired as the main interface.
1766 Tumme provides functionality to generate simple image galleries.
1767
1768 +++
1769 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1770
1771 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1772 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1773 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1774 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1775 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1776 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1777 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1778 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1779 `rsync' to do the copying).
1780
1781 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1782 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1783
1784 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1785
1786 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1787
1788 Removing Tramp, and re-enabling Ange-FTP, can be achieved by M-x
1789 tramp-unload-tramp.
1790
1791 ---
1792 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1793
1794 ---
1795 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1796 configuration files.
1797
1798 +++
1799 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1800 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1801 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1802 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1803 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1804 recognized.
1805
1806 ---
1807 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1808
1809 +++
1810 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1811
1812 ---
1813 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1814 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1815
1816 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1817 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1818 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1819 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1820 boundaries during scrolling.
1821 \f
1822 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1823
1824 ** Changes in Hi Lock:
1825
1826 +++
1827 *** hi-lock-mode now only affects a single buffer, and a new function
1828 `global-hi-lock-mode' enables Hi Lock in all buffers. By default, if
1829 hi-lock-mode is used in what appears to be the initialization file, a
1830 warning message suggests to use global-hi-lock-mode instead. However,
1831 if the new variable `hi-lock-archaic-interface-deduce' is non-nil,
1832 using hi-lock-mode in an initialization file will turn on Hi Lock in all
1833 buffers and no warning will be issued (for compatibility with the
1834 behavior in older versions of Emacs).
1835
1836 ** Changes in Allout
1837
1838 *** Topic cryptography added, enabling easy gpg topic encryption and
1839 decryption. Per-topic basis enables interspersing encrypted-text and
1840 clear-text within a single file to your hearts content, using symmetric
1841 and/or public key modes. Time-limited key caching, user-provided
1842 symmetric key hinting and consistency verification, auto-encryption of
1843 pending topics on save, and more, make it easy to use encryption in
1844 powerful ways.
1845
1846 *** many substantial fixes and refinements, including:
1847
1848 - repaired inhibition of inadvertent edits to concealed text
1849 - repaired retention of topic body hanging indent upon topic depth shifts
1850 - prevent "containment discontinuities" where a topic is shifted deeper
1851 than the offspring-depth of its container
1852 - easy to adopt the distinctive bullet of a topic in a topic created
1853 relative to it, or select a new one, or use the common topic bullet
1854 - plain bullets, by default, now alternate between only two characters
1855 ('.' and ','), yielding less cluttered outlines
1856 - many internal fixes
1857 - version number incremented to 2.1
1858
1859 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1860 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1861 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1862 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1863 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1864
1865 ---
1866 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1867
1868 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1869 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1870
1871 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1872 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1873 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1874
1875 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1876 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1877 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1878 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1879 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1880
1881 ---
1882 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake.
1883
1884 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three
1885 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1886 faces.
1887
1888 +++
1889 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1890 of the file that precede the first header line.
1891
1892 +++
1893 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1894
1895 ---
1896 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1897 run most curses applications now.
1898
1899 +++
1900 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1901
1902 +++
1903 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1904 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1905 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1906
1907 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1908 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1909 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1910
1911 ---
1912 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1913 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1914
1915 ---
1916 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1917 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1918 incompatible change.
1919
1920 ---
1921 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1922
1923 +++
1924 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1925 resync points in both windows.
1926
1927 +++
1928 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1929
1930 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1931 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1932
1933 ---
1934 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1935 when Emacs visits them.
1936
1937 ** Info mode changes:
1938
1939 +++
1940 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1941 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1942
1943 +++
1944 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1945
1946 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1947 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1948 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1949 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1950 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1951 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1952 Info node.
1953
1954 ---
1955 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1956 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1957 search without prompting for a new search string.
1958
1959 +++
1960 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1961 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1962 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1963
1964 ---
1965 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1966
1967 ---
1968 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1969 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1970
1971 +++
1972 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1973 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1974 possible matches.
1975
1976 ---
1977 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1978 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1979 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1980
1981 +++
1982 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1983 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1984
1985 ---
1986 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1987 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1988
1989 +++
1990 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1991
1992 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1993 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1994
1995 ---
1996 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1997
1998 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1999 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
2000 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
2001
2002 +++
2003 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
2004
2005 ---
2006 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
2007
2008 ** Lisp mode changes:
2009
2010 ---
2011 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
2012
2013 +++
2014 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
2015
2016 *** New features in evaluation commands
2017
2018 +++
2019 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
2020 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
2021
2022 +++
2023 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
2024 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
2025 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
2026 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
2027 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
2028
2029 +++
2030 ** CC mode changes.
2031
2032 *** The CC Mode manual has been extensively revised.
2033 The information about using CC Mode has been separated from the larger
2034 and more difficult chapters about configuration.
2035
2036 *** Changes in Key Sequences
2037 **** c-toggle-auto-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-t.
2038
2039 **** c-toggle-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-d.
2040 This binding has been taken over by c-hungry-delete-forwards.
2041
2042 **** c-toggle-auto-state (C-c C-t) has been renamed to c-toggle-auto-newline.
2043 c-toggle-auto-state remains as an alias.
2044
2045 **** The new commands c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forwards
2046 have key bindings C-c C-DEL (or C-c DEL, for the benefit of TTYs) and
2047 C-c C-d (or C-c C-<delete> or C-c <delete>) respectively. These
2048 commands delete entire blocks of whitespace with a single
2049 key-sequence. [N.B. "DEL" is the <backspace> key.]
2050
2051 **** The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l.
2052
2053 **** The new command c-subword-mode is bound to C-c C-w.
2054
2055 *** C-c C-s (`c-show-syntactic-information') now highlights the anchor
2056 position(s).
2057
2058 *** New Minor Modes
2059 **** Electric Minor Mode toggles the electric action of non-alphabetic keys.
2060 The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l. Turning the
2061 mode off can be helpful for editing chaotically indented code and for
2062 users new to CC Mode, who sometimes find electric indentation
2063 disconcerting. Its current state is displayed in the mode line with an
2064 'l', e.g. "C/al".
2065
2066 **** Subword Minor Mode makes Emacs recognize word boundaries at upper case
2067 letters in StudlyCapsIdentifiers. You enable this feature by C-c C-w. It can
2068 also be used in non-CC Mode buffers. :-) Contributed by Masatake YAMATO.
2069
2070 *** New clean-ups
2071
2072 **** `comment-close-slash'.
2073 With this clean-up, a block (i.e. c-style) comment can be terminated by
2074 typing a slash at the start of a line.
2075
2076 **** `c-one-liner-defun'
2077 This clean-up compresses a short enough defun (for example, an AWK
2078 pattern/action pair) onto a single line. "Short enough" is configurable.
2079
2080 *** Font lock support.
2081 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
2082 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
2083 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
2084 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
2085 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
2086 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
2087
2088 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
2089 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
2090 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
2091 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
2092 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
2093 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
2094 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
2095 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
2096 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
2097
2098 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
2099 fontification in mind; Just-In-Time-Lock mode should be enabled for
2100 the highest font lock level (by default, it is). Fontifying a file
2101 with several thousand lines in one go can take the better part of a
2102 minute.
2103
2104 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
2105 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
2106 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2107 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2108 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2109 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2110
2111 **** Support for documentation comments.
2112 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2113 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2114 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2115 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2116
2117 Currently three kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Sun's
2118 Javadoc, Autodoc (which is used in Pike) and GtkDoc (used in C). (The
2119 last was contributed by Masatake YAMATO). This is by no means a
2120 complete list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor
2121 of choice is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2122
2123 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2124 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2125 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2126 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2127 parens.
2128
2129 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2130 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2131 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2132 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2133 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2134
2135 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2136 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2137 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2138 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2139 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2140
2141 *** Support for the AWK language.
2142 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2143 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2144 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2145 Here is a summary:
2146
2147 **** Indentation Engine
2148 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2149
2150 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2151 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2152 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2153 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2154 definition, or structured statement.
2155
2156 The predefined line-up functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2157 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't
2158 be any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2159
2160 **** Font Locking
2161 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2162 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2163 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2164 the AWK language itself.
2165
2166 **** Comment and Movement Commands
2167 These commands all work for AWK buffers. The notion of "defun" has
2168 been augmented to include AWK pattern-action pairs - the standard
2169 "defun" commands on key sequences C-M-a, C-M-e, and C-M-h use this
2170 extended definition.
2171
2172 **** "awk" style, Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2173 A new style, "awk" has been introduced, and this is now the default
2174 style for AWK code. With auto-newline enabled, the clean-up
2175 c-one-liner-defun (see above) is useful.
2176
2177 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2178 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2179 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2180 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2181 composition-close, and incomposition.
2182
2183 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2184 The new functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward'
2185 provide hungry deletion without having to toggle a mode. They are
2186 bound to C-c C-DEL and C-c C-d (and several variants, for the benefit
2187 of different keyboard setups. See "Changes in key sequences" above).
2188
2189 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2190
2191 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2192 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2193 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2194 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2195
2196 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2197 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2198
2199 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2200
2201 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2202 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2203 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2204 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2205
2206 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2207
2208 is now analyzed as
2209
2210 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2211
2212 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2213 symbol.
2214
2215 This change might affect code that calls `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2216 directly, and custom lineup functions if they use
2217 `c-syntactic-context'. However, the argument given to lineup
2218 functions is still a single cons cell with nil or an integer in the
2219 cdr.
2220
2221 *** API changes for derived modes.
2222
2223 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2224 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2225 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2226 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2227 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2228
2229 **** New language variable system.
2230 These are variables whose values vary between CC Mode's different
2231 languages. See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2232
2233 **** New initialization functions.
2234 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2235 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2236 `c-init-language-vars'.
2237
2238 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2239 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2240 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2241 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2242
2243 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2244 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2245 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2246 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2247 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2248
2249 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2250 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2251 its substatement. E.g:
2252
2253 if (x)
2254 x_is_true:
2255 do_stuff();
2256
2257 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2258
2259 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2260 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2261 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2262 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2263 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2264 inside `#define's.
2265
2266 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2267
2268 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2269 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2270 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2271 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2272 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2273 empty lines within the macro better.
2274
2275 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2276 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2277 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2278
2279 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2280 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2281 variable `c-backslash-max-column' puts a limit on how far out
2282 backslashes can be moved.
2283
2284 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2285 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2286 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2287 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2288
2289 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2290 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2291 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2292 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2293 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2294 backslash) in the macro.
2295
2296 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2297 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2298 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior is
2299 based on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after
2300 #else and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other
2301 cases (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2302
2303 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2304 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2305
2306 *** New lineup functions
2307
2308 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2309 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2310 continues. E.g:
2311
2312 result = prefix + "A message "
2313 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2314
2315 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2316 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2317
2318 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2319 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2320 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2321
2322 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2323 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2324
2325 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2326 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2327
2328 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2329 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2330 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2331 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2332 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2333 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2334
2335 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2336 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2337 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2338 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2339 context.
2340
2341 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2342 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2343 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2344 happen when macros are involved.
2345
2346 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2347 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2348 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2349 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2350 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2351 line is left untouched.
2352
2353 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2354 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2355 syntactic indentation.
2356
2357 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2358 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2359
2360 ---
2361 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2362
2363 ---
2364 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2365 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2366 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2367 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2368
2369 ** Fortran mode changes:
2370
2371 ---
2372 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2373 highlighting for the old default.
2374
2375 +++
2376 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2377 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2378 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2379
2380 +++
2381 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2382 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2383 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2384 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2385
2386 ---
2387 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2388 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2389 majority.
2390
2391 ---
2392 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2393 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2394
2395 ---
2396 ** Reftex mode changes
2397
2398 +++
2399 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2400
2401 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2402 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2403 support for multifile documents.
2404
2405 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2406 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2407 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2408 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2409 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2410 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2411 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2412 with the `d' key.
2413
2414 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2415 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2416
2417 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2418 key `M-%'.
2419
2420 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2421 location.
2422
2423 +++
2424 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2425
2426 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2427 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2428 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2429
2430 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2431 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2432 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2433 citation selection buffer.
2434
2435 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2436 cursor as a default search string.
2437
2438 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2439 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2440
2441 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2442 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2443
2444 Support for jurabib has been added.
2445
2446 +++
2447 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2448
2449 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2450 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2451
2452 +++
2453 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2454
2455 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2456 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2457 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2458 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2459 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2460 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2461
2462 +++
2463 *** Miscellaneous changes
2464
2465 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2466 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2467
2468 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2469
2470 +++
2471 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2472 to support use of font-lock.
2473
2474 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2475
2476 ---
2477 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2478 automatically.
2479
2480 +++
2481 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2482 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2483 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2484 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2485 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2486 from the file name or buffer contents.
2487
2488 +++
2489 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2490
2491 ** TeX modes:
2492
2493 +++
2494 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2495
2496 +++
2497 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2498 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2499 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2500 TeX commands to use at startup.
2501
2502 ---
2503 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2504 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2505
2506 +++
2507 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2508
2509 ** BibTeX mode:
2510
2511 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2512 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2513
2514 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2515 an existing BibTeX entry by inserting fields that may occur but are not
2516 present.
2517
2518 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2519
2520 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2521 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2522 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2523 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2524 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2525 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2526
2527 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2528 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2529
2530 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2531 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2532
2533 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2534 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2535
2536 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2537 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2538
2539 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2540 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2541 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2542
2543 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2544 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2545
2546 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2547 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2548
2549 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2550 in multiple BibTeX files.
2551
2552 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2553 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2554
2555 *** The new variables bibtex-expand-strings and
2556 bibtex-autokey-expand-strings control the expansion of strings when
2557 extracting the content of a BibTeX field.
2558
2559 +++
2560 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2561 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2562 and `C-c C-r'.
2563
2564 ** GUD changes:
2565
2566 +++
2567 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2568 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2569
2570 ---
2571 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2572 and other common debugger commands.
2573
2574 +++
2575 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2576 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2577 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2578 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2579 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2580 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2581 breakpoints.
2582
2583 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2584
2585 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2586 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2587 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2588
2589 +++
2590 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2591 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2592 not executing.
2593
2594 ---
2595 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2596
2597 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class information.
2598 Fast startup since there is no need to scan all source files up front.
2599 There is also no need to create and maintain lists of source
2600 directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath' and
2601 `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2602
2603 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2604 set/clear operations from Java source files under the classpath, stack
2605 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2606 (gud-finish).
2607
2608 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2609 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2610
2611 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2612 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2613 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2614
2615 *** Added Customization Variables
2616
2617 **** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2618
2619 **** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2620 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2621 java sources (previous method).
2622
2623 **** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for Java
2624 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2625 is nil).
2626
2627 *** Minor Improvements
2628
2629 **** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2630 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2631 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2632 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2633 `starttls' tool).
2634
2635 **** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2636
2637 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2638
2639 +++
2640 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2641
2642 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2643 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2644 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2645 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2646 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2647 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2648 be mode dependent.
2649
2650 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2651 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2652 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2653 toggles this mode.
2654
2655 +++
2656 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2657 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2658 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2659 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2660 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2661 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2662 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2663 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2664 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2665
2666 +++
2667 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2668 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2669 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2670 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2671 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2672
2673 ---
2674 ** recentf changes.
2675
2676 The recent file list is now automatically cleaned up when recentf mode is
2677 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2678 automatic cleanup.
2679
2680 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2681 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2682 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2683
2684 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2685 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2686 keep in the recent list.
2687
2688 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2689 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2690 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2691 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2692 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2693
2694 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2695 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2696 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2697
2698 +++
2699 ** Desktop package
2700
2701 +++
2702 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2703
2704 +++
2705 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2706
2707 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2708
2709 ---
2710 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2711 buffer list.
2712
2713 +++
2714 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2715 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2716 idle).
2717
2718 +++
2719 *** New commands:
2720 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2721 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2722 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2723 it was loaded.
2724 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2725 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2726
2727 ---
2728 *** New customizable variables:
2729 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2730 killed.
2731 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2732 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2733 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2734 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2735 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2736 should not delete.
2737 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2738 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2739 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2740 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2741
2742 +++
2743 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2744
2745 ---
2746 *** New hooks:
2747 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2748 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2749
2750 ---
2751 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2752
2753 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2754 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2755 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2756 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2757 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2758 feature.
2759
2760 ** EDiff changes.
2761
2762 +++
2763 *** When comparing directories.
2764 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2765 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2766 from one directory to another.
2767
2768 +++
2769 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2770 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2771 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2772 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2773 comparison.
2774
2775 +++
2776 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2777 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2778 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2779
2780 +++
2781 ** Etags changes.
2782
2783 *** New regular expressions features
2784
2785 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2786
2787 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2788 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2789 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2790 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2791 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2792 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2793 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2794 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2795 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2796 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2797
2798 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2799
2800 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2801 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2802 CR, TAB, VT.
2803
2804 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2805
2806 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2807 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2808 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2809
2810 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2811
2812 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2813 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2814
2815 *** New language parsing features
2816
2817 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2818
2819 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2820
2821 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2822
2823 **** New language HTML.
2824
2825 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2826 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2827
2828 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2829
2830 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2831 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2832
2833 **** New language Lua.
2834
2835 All functions are tagged.
2836
2837 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2838
2839 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2840 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2841 package::sub.
2842
2843 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2844
2845 **** New language PHP.
2846
2847 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2848 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2849
2850 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2851
2852 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2853 renewenvironment.
2854
2855 *** Honour #line directives.
2856
2857 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2858 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2859 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2860 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2861 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2862
2863 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2864
2865 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2866 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2867 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2868 the file FILE.
2869
2870 ** VC Changes
2871
2872 +++
2873 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2874 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2875
2876 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2877 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2878 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2879 `.emacs' file:
2880
2881 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2882
2883 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2884
2885 +++
2886 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2887 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2888
2889 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2890 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2891 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2892
2893 +++
2894 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2895
2896 +++
2897 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2898
2899 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2900 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2901 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2902
2903 P: annotates the previous revision
2904 N: annotates the next revision
2905 J: annotates the revision at line
2906 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2907 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2908 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2909 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2910
2911 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2912
2913 +++
2914 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2915 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2916 in the repository.
2917
2918 +++
2919 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2920 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2921 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2922 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2923
2924 +++
2925 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2926 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2927 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2928
2929 +++
2930 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2931
2932 See the documentation of the user option
2933 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2934
2935 ** Rmail changes:
2936
2937 ---
2938 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2939
2940 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
2941 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
2942 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
2943
2944 +++
2945 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2946
2947 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2948 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2949 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2950 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2951 used instead of the native one.
2952
2953 ** Gnus package
2954
2955 ---
2956 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2957
2958 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2959 PGP/MIME.
2960
2961 ---
2962 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2963
2964 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2965
2966 ---
2967 ** MH-E changes.
2968
2969 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.85. There have been major changes since
2970 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2971
2972 ** Calendar changes:
2973
2974 +++
2975 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
2976 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
2977
2978 +++
2979 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2980 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2981
2982 +++
2983 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2984 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2985 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2986 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2987 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2988 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2989 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2990 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2991 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2992
2993 +++
2994 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2995 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2996 count backward from the end of the year.
2997
2998 +++
2999 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
3000 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
3001 day of that ISO week.
3002
3003 ---
3004 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
3005 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
3006
3007 ---
3008 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
3009 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
3010 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
3011 `christian-holidays' simpler.
3012
3013 ---
3014 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
3015 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
3016 and `diary-header-line-format'.
3017
3018 +++
3019 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
3020 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
3021 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
3022 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
3023
3024 +++
3025 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
3026 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
3027 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
3028 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
3029 formats.
3030
3031 +++
3032 ** Speedbar changes:
3033
3034 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
3035 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
3036
3037 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
3038 keymap.
3039
3040 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
3041 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
3042
3043 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
3044
3045 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
3046 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
3047 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
3048 its descendents.
3049
3050 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
3051 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
3052 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
3053 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
3054 deletion.
3055
3056 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
3057 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
3058 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
3059 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
3060 that number to `other-frame'.
3061
3062 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
3063 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
3064
3065 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
3066 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
3067 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
3068 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
3069 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
3070 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
3071 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
3072 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
3073 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
3074
3075 ---
3076 ** sql changes.
3077
3078 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
3079 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
3080 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
3081 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
3082 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
3083
3084 The following values are supported:
3085
3086 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
3087 db2 DB2
3088 informix Informix
3089 ingres Ingres
3090 interbase Interbase
3091 linter Linter
3092 ms Microsoft
3093 mysql MySQL
3094 oracle Oracle
3095 postgres Postgres
3096 solid Solid
3097 sqlite SQLite
3098 sybase Sybase
3099
3100 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
3101 SQL mode indicator.
3102
3103 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
3104 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
3105 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
3106
3107 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
3108
3109 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
3110 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
3111 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
3112 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
3113
3114 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
3115 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3116
3117 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3118
3119 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3120 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3121
3122 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3123
3124 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3125 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3126 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3127 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3128 terminated.
3129
3130 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3131 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3132 credentials to authenticate the user.
3133
3134 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3135 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3136 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3137
3138 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3139 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3140
3141 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3142 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3143 defaults.
3144
3145 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3146 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3147 `sql-product'.
3148
3149 ---
3150 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3151
3152 ** FFAP changes:
3153
3154 +++
3155 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3156
3157 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3158 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3159 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3160 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3161
3162 ---
3163 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3164
3165 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3166 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3167
3168 ---
3169 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3170
3171 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3172 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3173 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3174 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3175 with other details of skeleton construction.
3176
3177 ---
3178 ** Hideshow mode changes
3179
3180 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3181 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3182 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3183 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3184
3185 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3186 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3187 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3188
3189 +++
3190 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3191 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3192 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3193
3194 ---
3195 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3196
3197 ---
3198 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3199 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3200 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3201 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3202
3203 ---
3204 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3205
3206 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3207 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3208 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3209
3210 ---
3211 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3212 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3213 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3214 using strokes as an input method.
3215
3216 ** Emacs server changes:
3217
3218 +++
3219 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3220
3221 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3222 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3223 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3224 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3225
3226 +++
3227 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3228 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3229 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3230
3231 +++
3232 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3233
3234 ---
3235 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3236
3237 +++
3238 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3239
3240 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3241 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3242 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3243
3244 ---
3245 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3246 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3247
3248 ---
3249 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3250
3251 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3252 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3253 inverse-video.
3254
3255 ---
3256 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3257
3258 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3259 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3260 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3261
3262 ** battery.el changes:
3263
3264 ---
3265 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3266
3267 ---
3268 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3269
3270 ---
3271 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3272
3273 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3274 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3275 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3276 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3277
3278 ---
3279 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3280
3281 ---
3282 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3283
3284 ---
3285 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3286 \f
3287 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3288
3289 +++
3290 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3291
3292 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3293 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3294 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3295 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3296 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3297 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3298 where USERNAME is your user name.
3299
3300 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3301 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3302 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3303
3304 +++
3305 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3306
3307 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3308 existing values. For example:
3309
3310 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3311
3312 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3313 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3314
3315 ---
3316 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3317
3318 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3319 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3320
3321 ---
3322 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3323
3324 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3325
3326 ---
3327 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3328
3329 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3330 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3331 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3332 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3333 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3334 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3335
3336 ---
3337 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3338
3339 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3340 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3341 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3342 sound support for those formats.
3343
3344 ---
3345 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3346
3347 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3348
3349 ---
3350 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3351
3352 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3353 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3354 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3355
3356 ---
3357 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3358
3359 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3360 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3361 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3362 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3363 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3364 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3365 you wish to use them in other faces.
3366
3367 ---
3368 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3369
3370 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3371 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3372 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3373 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3374 any customizations.
3375
3376 ---
3377 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3378
3379 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3380 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3381 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3382 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favours local console
3383 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3384 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3385 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3386 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3387 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3388 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3389
3390 ---
3391 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3392
3393 ---
3394 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3395 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3396 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3397
3398 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3399 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3400 \f
3401 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3402
3403 ---
3404 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3405 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3406
3407 +++
3408 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3409 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3410 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3411 `undefined'.)
3412
3413 +++
3414 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3415 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3416 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3417
3418 ---
3419 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3420
3421 +++
3422 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3423 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3424 \f
3425 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3426
3427 ** General Lisp changes:
3428
3429 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3430 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3431 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3432
3433 +++
3434 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3435
3436 +++
3437 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3438
3439 +++
3440 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3441
3442 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3443 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3444 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3445
3446 +++
3447 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3448 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3449
3450 +++
3451 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3452
3453 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3454
3455 +++
3456 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3457
3458 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3459 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3460 first one.
3461
3462 +++
3463 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3464
3465 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3466 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3467
3468 +++
3469 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3470
3471 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3472 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3473 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3474 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3475
3476 +++
3477 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3478
3479 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3480
3481 +++
3482 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3483
3484 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3485 longer accepted.
3486
3487 +++
3488 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3489
3490 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3491 cyclic.
3492
3493 +++
3494 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3495
3496 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3497 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3498
3499 +++
3500 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3501
3502 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3503 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3504 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3505
3506 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3507 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3508
3509 +++
3510 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3511
3512 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3513 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3514 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3515
3516 +++
3517 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3518
3519 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3520 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3521 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3522
3523 +++
3524 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3525
3526 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3527 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3528 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3529 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3530
3531 +++
3532 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3533
3534 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3535 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3536 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3537
3538 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3539 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3540
3541 +++
3542 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3543
3544 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3545
3546 +++
3547 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3548
3549 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3550 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3551 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc.).
3552
3553 +++
3554 *** New macro `eval-at-startup' specifies expressions to
3555 evaluate when Emacs starts up. If this is done after startup,
3556 it evaluates those expressions immediately.
3557
3558 This is useful in packages that can be preloaded.
3559
3560 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3561
3562 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3563
3564 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3565
3566 +++
3567 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3568
3569 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3570 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3571
3572 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3573
3574 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3575 possible declaration specifiers are:
3576
3577 (indent INDENT)
3578 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3579
3580 (edebug DEBUG)
3581 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3582 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3583 but this is cleaner.)
3584
3585 ---
3586 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3587
3588 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3589
3590 ---
3591 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3592
3593 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3594 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3595 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3596 forms.
3597
3598 +++
3599 ** Variable aliases:
3600
3601 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3602
3603 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3604 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3605 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3606 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3607
3608 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3609 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3610
3611 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3612
3613 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3614 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3615 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3616
3617 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3618 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3619
3620 +++
3621 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3622 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3623
3624 ** defcustom changes:
3625
3626 +++
3627 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3628
3629 ** String changes:
3630
3631 +++
3632 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3633
3634 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3635 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3636 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3637
3638 +++
3639 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3640
3641 +++
3642 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3643
3644 +++
3645 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3646 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3647 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3648 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3649 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3650
3651 +++
3652 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3653 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3654
3655 +++
3656 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3657 text properties.
3658
3659 +++
3660 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3661 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3662 been declared obsolete.
3663
3664 +++
3665 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3666
3667 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3668 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3669 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3670 warnings in a separate window.
3671
3672 +++
3673 ** Progress reporters.
3674
3675 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3676 progress messages for the user.
3677
3678 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3679 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3680 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3681
3682 ** Buffer positions:
3683
3684 +++
3685 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3686 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3687 the usable window height and width is used.
3688
3689 +++
3690 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3691 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3692 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3693 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3694 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3695
3696 +++
3697 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3698
3699 It defaults to 1.
3700
3701 +++
3702 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3703
3704 It defaults to 1.
3705
3706 +++
3707 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' tests if a position is in a clickable link.
3708
3709 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3710 functionality.
3711
3712 +++
3713 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3714
3715 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3716
3717 +++
3718 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3719
3720 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3721 give up and return LIMIT.
3722
3723 +++
3724 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3725 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3726 arg is non-nil.
3727
3728 +++
3729 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3730 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3731 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3732
3733 ** Text modification:
3734
3735 +++
3736 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3737 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3738 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3739
3740 +++
3741 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3742 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3743 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3744
3745 +++
3746 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3747 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3748 inserted substring.
3749
3750 +++
3751 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3752 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3753 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3754 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3755 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3756
3757 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3758 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3759 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3760 text.
3761
3762 +++
3763 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3764 argument.
3765
3766 +++
3767 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3768 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3769 be inserted is translated through it.
3770
3771 ---
3772 *** Text clones.
3773
3774 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3775 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3776 clone to the other.
3777
3778 ---
3779 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3780
3781 ** Filling changes.
3782
3783 +++
3784 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3785 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3786 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3787
3788 +++
3789 ** Atomic change groups.
3790
3791 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3792 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3793 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3794
3795 (atomic-change-group
3796 (insert foo)
3797 (delete-region x y))
3798
3799 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3800 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3801 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3802 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3803
3804 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3805 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3806
3807 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3808 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3809 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3810 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3811
3812 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3813 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3814 do this.
3815
3816 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3817 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3818 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3819 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3820
3821 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3822 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3823 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3824 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3825 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3826 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3827 twice.
3828
3829 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3830 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3831 returned values, like this:
3832
3833 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3834 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3835
3836 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3837 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3838 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3839
3840 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3841 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3842 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3843 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3844 finished.
3845
3846 ** Buffer-related changes:
3847
3848 ---
3849 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3850
3851 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3852
3853 +++
3854 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3855
3856 +++
3857 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3858 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3859 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3860 value of VARIABLE instead.
3861
3862 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
3863 various status records in parallel.
3864
3865 It takes a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
3866 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
3867 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
3868 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
3869 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
3870 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
3871 it returns nil.
3872
3873 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
3874 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
3875 vector into the variable and returns t.
3876
3877 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
3878 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
3879 purpose.
3880
3881 +++
3882 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
3883 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
3884 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
3885 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
3886
3887 ** Local variables lists:
3888
3889 +++
3890 *** Text properties in local variables.
3891
3892 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3893 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3894
3895 +++
3896 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3897 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3898 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3899 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3900 needed.
3901
3902 ---
3903 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3904 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3905 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3906 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3907 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3908 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3909
3910 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3911 confirmation as before.
3912
3913 ** Searching and matching changes:
3914
3915 +++
3916 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3917 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3918 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3919
3920 +++
3921 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3922 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3923 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3924 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3925
3926 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3927 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3928
3929 +++
3930 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3931
3932 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3933 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3934 specified by the syntax table.
3935
3936 ---
3937 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3938
3939 +++
3940 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3941 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3942 characters and ranges.
3943
3944 ---
3945 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3946 properties from surrounding text.
3947
3948 +++
3949 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3950 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3951 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3952
3953 +++
3954 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
3955 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
3956 passed to these functions will be reseated to point to nowhere.
3957
3958 +++
3959 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3960 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3961 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3962
3963 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3964 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3965 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3966 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3967 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3968
3969 ** Undo changes:
3970
3971 +++
3972 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3973
3974 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3975 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3976 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3977
3978 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3979 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3980 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3981
3982 +++
3983 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3984 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3985 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3986
3987 +++
3988 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3989 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3990
3991 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3992 elements with the following format:
3993 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3994
3995 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3996 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3997 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3998 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3999
4000 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
4001 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
4002 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
4003 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
4004 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
4005 rectangle.
4006 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
4007 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
4008 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
4009 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
4010 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
4011 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
4012 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
4013 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
4014
4015 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
4016 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
4017 the killed text.
4018
4019 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
4020 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
4021 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
4022 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
4023 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
4024
4025 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
4026 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
4027 string. The old behavior is available if you call
4028 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
4029
4030 ** Syntax table changes:
4031
4032 +++
4033 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
4034
4035 +++
4036 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
4037 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4038 of text properties as well as the character code.
4039
4040 +++
4041 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4042 by `syntax-after').
4043
4044 +++
4045 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
4046 current syntactic context at point.
4047
4048 ** File operation changes:
4049
4050 +++
4051 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4052 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
4053
4054 +++
4055 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4056 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4057 operation.
4058
4059 +++
4060 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4061 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4062 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4063 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4064
4065 +++
4066 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
4067 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
4068
4069 +++
4070 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4071 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4072 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4073
4074 +++
4075 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4076
4077 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4078
4079 +++
4080 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4081 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4082
4083 +++
4084 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4085 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
4086 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
4087 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
4088
4089 +++
4090 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
4091 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
4092 tasks. For example, it can be used by the copyright package to make
4093 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
4094
4095 +++
4096 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
4097 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
4098 it's modified).
4099
4100 +++
4101 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
4102 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
4103 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
4104 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
4105 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
4106 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
4107 further filter candidate files.
4108
4109 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
4110 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
4111 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependencies.
4112
4113 ---
4114 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
4115
4116 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
4117 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
4118 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
4119 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
4120 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4121
4122 +++
4123 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
4124
4125 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
4126 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
4127 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
4128 operations.
4129
4130 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4131 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4132
4133 +++
4134 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4135 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4136
4137 ** Input changes:
4138
4139 +++
4140 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4141 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4142 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4143
4144 +++
4145 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4146 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4147 it returns just the directory name.
4148
4149 ---
4150 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4151 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4152 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4153
4154 +++
4155 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4156 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4157 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4158 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4159 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4160
4161 ** Minibuffer changes:
4162
4163 +++
4164 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4165 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4166 defaults to the current buffer.
4167
4168 +++
4169 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4170 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4171
4172 +++
4173 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4174 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4175
4176 +++
4177 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4178 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
4179 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4180 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4181 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4182
4183 ---
4184 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4185 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4186
4187 +++
4188 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4189 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4190 `read-file-name' function.
4191
4192 +++
4193 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name.
4194
4195 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4196 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4197
4198 ** Completion changes:
4199
4200 +++
4201 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents
4202 of the minibuffer just before point. That is what completion commands
4203 operate on.
4204
4205 +++
4206 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4207 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4208 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4209 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4210 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4211
4212 +++
4213 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4214 as a dynamic completion table.
4215
4216 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4217
4218 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4219 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4220 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4221 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4222 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4223 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4224
4225 +++
4226 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4227 as a lazy completion table.
4228
4229 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN)
4230
4231 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4232 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with no
4233 arguments. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR.
4234 If completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4235 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4236 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4237
4238 +++
4239 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4240
4241 *** New keymaps for typing file names
4242
4243 Two new keymaps, `minibuffer-local-filename-completion-map' and
4244 `minibuffer-local-must-match-filename-map', apply whenever
4245 Emacs reads a file name in the minibuffer. These key maps override
4246 the usual binding of SPC to `minibuffer-complete-word' (so that file
4247 names with embedded spaces could be typed without the need to quote
4248 the spaces).
4249
4250 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4251
4252 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4253 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4254 example,
4255
4256 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4257
4258 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4259
4260 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4261 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4262 binding and lookup functionality.
4263
4264 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4265 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4266 original command.
4267
4268 Example:
4269 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4270 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4271 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4272 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4273 `kill-word'.
4274
4275 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4276 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4277 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4278
4279 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4280 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4281
4282 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4283 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4284
4285 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4286 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4287 runs `my-kill-line'.
4288
4289 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4290
4291 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4292 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4293 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4294 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4295
4296 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4297 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4298
4299 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4300 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4301
4302 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4303 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4304 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4305 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4306 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4307 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4308
4309 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4310 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4311 command was not remapped.
4312
4313 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4314 over minor mode keymaps.
4315
4316 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4317 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4318 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4319
4320 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4321
4322 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4323 bindings of the parent keymap.
4324
4325 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4326
4327 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4328 active keymaps.
4329
4330 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4331 defined keys and their definitions.
4332
4333 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4334
4335 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4336 in the keymap.
4337
4338 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4339
4340 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4341 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4342 keymap alist to this list.
4343
4344 ** Abbrev changes:
4345
4346 +++
4347 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4348
4349 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4350
4351 +++
4352 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4353
4354 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4355 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4356 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4357 specify this flag.
4358
4359 +++
4360 ** Enhancements to process support
4361
4362 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4363 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4364
4365 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4366
4367 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4368 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4369 functions.
4370
4371 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4372 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4373
4374 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4375 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4376
4377 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4378 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4379 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4380 entire property list of a process.
4381
4382 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4383 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4384 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4385 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4386 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4387 speech synthesis.
4388
4389 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4390
4391 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4392 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4393 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4394 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4395 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4396 from such processes, allowing them to produce more output before
4397 emacs tries to read it.
4398
4399 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4400
4401 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4402
4403 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4404 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4405 `default-directory'.
4406
4407 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4408 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4409
4410 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4411 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4412 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4413
4414 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4415 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4416
4417 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4418 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4419
4420 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4421 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4422 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4423 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4424 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4425
4426 +++
4427 ** Enhanced networking support.
4428
4429 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4430 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4431 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4432
4433 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4434 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4435 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4436 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4437 - IPv6 is supported (when available). You may explicitly select IPv6
4438 using :family 'ipv6 arg.
4439 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4440 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4441 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4442 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4443
4444 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4445 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4446 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:family ipv6))
4447
4448 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4449
4450 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4451
4452 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4453 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4454
4455 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4456
4457 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4458 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4459 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4460 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4461 string for other formatting options.
4462
4463 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4464
4465 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4466 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4467 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4468
4469 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4470 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4471
4472 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4473
4474 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4475 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4476 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4477 stopped state.
4478
4479 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4480
4481 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4482 current network addresses.
4483
4484 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4485
4486 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4487 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4488
4489 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4490
4491 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4492 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4493 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4494 "connection broken by remote peer".
4495
4496 ** Using window objects:
4497
4498 +++
4499 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4500
4501 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4502 header line.
4503
4504 +++
4505 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4506
4507 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4508 or the header line.
4509
4510 +++
4511 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4512
4513 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4514 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4515 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4516 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4517 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4518
4519 +++
4520 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4521 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4522 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4523 the mode line.
4524
4525 +++
4526 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4527 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4528
4529 +++
4530 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4531 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4532 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4533
4534 +++
4535 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4536
4537 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4538
4539 +++
4540 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4541 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4542 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4543 buffer.
4544
4545 +++
4546 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4547
4548 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4549 and scroll-bar settings.
4550
4551 +++
4552 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4553
4554 +++
4555 *** The functions `get-lru-window' and `get-largest-window' take an optional
4556 argument `dedicated'. If non-nil, those functions do not ignore
4557 dedicated windows.
4558
4559 +++
4560 *** The new function `adjust-window-trailing-edge' moves the right
4561 or bottom edge of a window. It does not move other window edges.
4562
4563 +++
4564 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4565
4566 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4567 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4568
4569 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4570 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation' or `continued-line'.
4571
4572 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4573 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4574
4575 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4576 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4577 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4578 foreground color of the bitmap.
4579
4580 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4581 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4582 bitmap of the display line.
4583
4584 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4585 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4586 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4587 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4588 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4589
4590 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4591 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4592
4593 ** Other window fringe features:
4594
4595 +++
4596 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4597
4598 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4599 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4600 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4601 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4602
4603 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4604 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4605 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4606 between the left and right fringe. To force a specific fringe width,
4607 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4608 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4609
4610 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4611 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4612 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4613 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4614
4615 +++
4616 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4617
4618 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4619 position settings.
4620
4621 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4622 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4623 `set-window-fringes'.
4624
4625 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4626 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4627 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4628 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4629
4630 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4631 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4632 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4633 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4634 an update of the display margins.
4635
4636 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4637 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4638
4639 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4640 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4641 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4642 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4643 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4644 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4645 of the display margins.
4646
4647 ** Redisplay features:
4648
4649 +++
4650 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4651
4652 +++
4653 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4654 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4655 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4656 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4657 forcing an explicit window update.
4658
4659 +++
4660 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4661 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4662 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4663
4664 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4665 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4666
4667 +++
4668 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4669 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4670
4671 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4672 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4673
4674 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4675 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4676 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4677 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4678 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4679 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4680
4681 +++
4682 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4683
4684 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4685 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4686
4687 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4688 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4689 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4690 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4691 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4692
4693 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4694 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4695 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4696
4697 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4698 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4699 the given value.
4700
4701 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4702 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4703 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4704
4705 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4706 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4707
4708 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4709 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4710 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4711 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4712 exactly that many pixels high.
4713
4714 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4715 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4716 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4717 the `line-spacing' variable.
4718
4719 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4720 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4721
4722 +++
4723 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4724 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4725
4726 +++
4727 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4728
4729 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4730 PROPS is a property list, now allows pixel based width and height
4731 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4732
4733 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4734 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4735 are supported:
4736
4737 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4738 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4739 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4740 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4741 | scroll-bar | text
4742 POS ::= left | center | right
4743 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4744 OP ::= + | -
4745
4746 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4747 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4748 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4749 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4750 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4751 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4752 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4753 the image.
4754
4755 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4756 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4757 corresponding area of the window.
4758
4759 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4760 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4761 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4762 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4763 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4764 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4765 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4766 the width of the area.
4767
4768 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4769 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4770
4771 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4772 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4773 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4774
4775 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4776 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4777 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4778 height) of the specified image.
4779
4780 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4781 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4782
4783 +++
4784 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4785 text property string that may be present at the current window
4786 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4787 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4788
4789 +++
4790 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4791 supported on text terminals.
4792
4793 +++
4794 *** Support for displaying image slices
4795
4796 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4797 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4798
4799 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4800 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4801
4802 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4803 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4804
4805 +++
4806 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4807
4808 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4809 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4810 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4811 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4812 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4813 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4814 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4815 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4816
4817 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4818 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4819 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4820 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4821 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4822 for possible pointer shapes.
4823
4824 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4825 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4826 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4827
4828 +++
4829 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4830 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4831 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4832 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4833 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4834 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4835 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4836
4837 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4838
4839 +++
4840 *** The new variable `max-image-size' defines the maximum size of
4841 images that Emacs will load and display.
4842
4843 ** Mouse pointer features:
4844
4845 +++ (lispref)
4846 ??? (man)
4847 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4848 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4849 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4850 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4851 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4852
4853 +++
4854 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4855 :pointer image property.
4856
4857 +++
4858 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4859 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4860
4861 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4862
4863 +++
4864 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4865 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4866
4867 +++
4868 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4869 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4870 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4871
4872 +++
4873 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4874
4875 +++
4876 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4877
4878 +++
4879 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4880 text area).
4881
4882 +++
4883 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4884 and all areas.
4885
4886 +++
4887 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4888 of the mouse event position.
4889
4890 +++
4891 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4892
4893 +++
4894 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4895 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4896
4897 +++
4898 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4899 (image or character) clicked on.
4900
4901 +++
4902 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4903
4904 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4905 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4906 the total width and height of that object.
4907
4908 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4909
4910 +++
4911 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4912 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4913
4914 +++
4915 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4916
4917 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4918 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4919 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4920 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4921
4922 +++
4923 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4924 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4925 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4926 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4927 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4928
4929 +++
4930 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4931
4932 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4933 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4934
4935 ** Face changes
4936
4937 +++
4938 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4939 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4940 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4941 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4942 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4943 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4944
4945 +++
4946 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4947 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4948
4949 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4950 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4951 defined with `defface'.
4952
4953 ---
4954 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4955 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4956 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4957 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4958 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4959
4960 +++
4961 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4962 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4963 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4964 by them).
4965
4966 +++
4967 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4968 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4969 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4970 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4971 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4972
4973 ---
4974 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4975 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4976 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4977
4978 +++
4979 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4980
4981 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4982 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4983 attribute.
4984
4985 +++
4986 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4987 help with handling relative face attributes.
4988
4989 +++
4990 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4991
4992 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4993 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4994 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4995 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4996 `face' properties.
4997
4998 ---
4999 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
5000 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
5001 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
5002 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
5003 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
5004
5005 ---
5006 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
5007 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
5008
5009 ** Font-Lock changes:
5010
5011 +++
5012 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
5013
5014 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
5015 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
5016 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
5017 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5018
5019 +++
5020 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
5021
5022 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
5023 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
5024 properties than `face'.
5025
5026 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
5027 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
5028
5029 ---
5030 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
5031
5032 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
5033 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
5034 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
5035 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
5036 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
5037
5038 s{
5039 foo
5040 }{
5041 bar
5042 }e
5043
5044 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
5045 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
5046 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
5047 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
5048
5049 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
5050
5051 +++
5052 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
5053 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
5054 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
5055 variable `magic-mode-alist'.
5056
5057 +++
5058 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
5059
5060 +++
5061 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
5062 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
5063 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
5064
5065 ---
5066 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5067 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5068 it in that buffer.
5069
5070 +++
5071 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
5072 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
5073 the language.
5074
5075 +++
5076 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
5077 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
5078
5079 +++
5080 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
5081 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
5082 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
5083
5084 ** Minor mode changes:
5085
5086 +++
5087 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
5088 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
5089
5090 +++
5091 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5092
5093 +++
5094 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
5095
5096 This is a new name for what was formerly called
5097 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
5098
5099 ** Command loop changes:
5100
5101 +++
5102 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
5103 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
5104 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
5105
5106 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
5107 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
5108
5109 +++
5110 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
5111
5112 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
5113 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
5114 macros.
5115
5116 +++
5117 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
5118 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
5119 covered by an image or composition property.
5120
5121 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
5122 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
5123 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
5124 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
5125 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5126
5127 +++
5128 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
5129 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
5130 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
5131 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
5132 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
5133
5134 +++
5135 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
5136 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
5137 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
5138
5139 +++
5140 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
5141 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
5142
5143 ** Lisp file loading changes:
5144
5145 +++
5146 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
5147 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
5148 current file redefined it).
5149
5150 +++
5151 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
5152 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
5153
5154 +++
5155 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
5156 variable or face definitions.
5157
5158 +++
5159 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5160 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5161 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5162
5163 ---
5164 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5165 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5166 than 3 levels of nesting.
5167
5168 +++
5169 ** Byte compiler changes:
5170
5171 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5172 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5173 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5174 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5175 compilation output buffer.
5176
5177 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5178 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5179
5180 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5181 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5182 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5183 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5184 forms:
5185
5186 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5187 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5188
5189 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5190 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5191 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5192 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5193 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5194 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5195
5196 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5197 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5198 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5199 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5200 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5201 you anything.
5202
5203 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5204
5205 ---
5206 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5207 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5208 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5209
5210 ** Frame operations:
5211
5212 +++
5213 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5214
5215 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5216 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5217
5218 +++
5219 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5220 for all (existing and future) frames.
5221
5222 +++
5223 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5224 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5225 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5226 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5227
5228 +++
5229 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5230 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5231
5232 ** Mule changes:
5233
5234 +++
5235 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5236
5237 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5238 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5239 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5240 now:
5241
5242 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5243
5244 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5245 the time it takes to convert the format.
5246
5247 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5248 wasteful.
5249
5250 ---
5251 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5252 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5253
5254 +++
5255 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5256 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5257 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5258 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5259
5260 ---
5261 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5262 of one coding system from another coding system.
5263
5264 ---
5265 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5266 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5267 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5268
5269 +++
5270 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5271 it is read from a file without decoding.
5272
5273 ---
5274 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5275 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5276
5277 ---
5278 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5279 current input method to input a character.
5280
5281 ** Mode line changes:
5282
5283 +++
5284 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5285
5286 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5287 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5288
5289 +++
5290 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5291 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5292
5293 +++
5294 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5295 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5296 line.
5297
5298 +++
5299 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5300
5301 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5302
5303 ---
5304 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5305 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5306 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5307 several versions ago.
5308
5309 ---
5310 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5311 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5312 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5313
5314 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5315 made with easy-menu.
5316
5317 ---
5318 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5319 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5320 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5321 need to have a name.
5322
5323 ** Operating system access:
5324
5325 +++
5326 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5327 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5328
5329 +++
5330 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5331 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5332 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5333
5334 +++
5335 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5336
5337 ---
5338 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5339 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5340 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5341
5342 ---
5343 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5344 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5345
5346 ** Miscellaneous:
5347
5348 +++
5349 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5350
5351 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5352 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5353 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5354 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5355 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5356 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5357 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5358
5359 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5360
5361 +++
5362 *** Variable `local-write-file-hooks' is marked obsolete.
5363
5364 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5365
5366 ---
5367 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5368 running under X.
5369
5370 ** GC changes:
5371
5372 +++
5373 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5374 as the heap size increases.
5375
5376 +++
5377 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5378 on garbage collection.
5379
5380 +++
5381 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5382
5383 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5384 \f
5385 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5386
5387 +++
5388 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5389 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5390 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5391 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5392 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5393
5394 ---
5395 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5396 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5397 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5398
5399 +++
5400 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5401 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5402 data structures.
5403
5404 ---
5405 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5406 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5407
5408 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5409 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5410 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5411 commands.
5412
5413 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5414 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5415 SQL buffer.
5416
5417 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5418 (function (lambda ()
5419 (master-mode t)
5420 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5421 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5422 (function (lambda ()
5423 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5424
5425 +++
5426 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5427
5428 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5429
5430 +++
5431 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5432
5433 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5434 code. It works with edebug.
5435
5436 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5437 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5438 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5439 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5440 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5441
5442 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5443 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5444 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5445 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5446 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5447 value, such as (setq x 14).
5448
5449 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5450 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5451 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5452 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5453 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5454 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5455 \f
5456 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5457
5458 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5459 been added.
5460
5461 \f
5462 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5463
5464 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5465 with Custom.
5466
5467 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5468 as mule-utf-8.
5469
5470 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5471 in UTF-8 locales).
5472
5473 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5474 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5475 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5476 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5477 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5478 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5479 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5480 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5481 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5482 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5483
5484 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5485 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5486
5487 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5488 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5489 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5490 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5491 contrary to the compound text specification.
5492
5493 \f
5494 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5495
5496 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5497
5498 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5499
5500 \f
5501 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5502
5503 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5504
5505 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5506 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5507 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5508 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5509 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5510
5511 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5512 were changed.
5513
5514 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5515 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5516
5517 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5518 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5519 instead of using default-major-mode.
5520
5521 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5522 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5523 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5524 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5525 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5526 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5527 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5528
5529 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5530 NEWS.
5531
5532 \f
5533 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5534
5535 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5536 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5537 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5538
5539 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5540 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5541
5542 \f
5543 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5544
5545 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5546 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5547 charsets in this release.
5548
5549 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5550
5551 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5552
5553 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5554 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5555 to list them.
5556
5557 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5558 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5559 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5560 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5561 necessary changes to unexec.
5562
5563 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5564 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5565
5566 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5567 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5568
5569 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5570 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5571
5572 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5573 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5574 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5575 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5576 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5577
5578 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5579 new display features described below.
5580
5581 \f
5582 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5583
5584 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5585
5586 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5587 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5588 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5589 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5590 the text.
5591
5592 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5593
5594 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5595 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5596 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5597 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5598 specify a font.
5599
5600 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5601 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5602 under Lisp changes, below.
5603
5604 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5605
5606 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5607 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5608 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5609 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5610 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5611 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5612 on terminals.
5613
5614 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5615 supported on character terminals.
5616
5617 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5618 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5619 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5620 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5621
5622 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5623
5624 ** Sound support
5625
5626 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5627 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5628 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5629 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5630 sound support.
5631
5632 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5633
5634 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5635 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5636 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5637 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5638
5639 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5640
5641 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5642 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5643 specifies a number of lines.
5644
5645 Default is 0.25.
5646
5647 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5648
5649 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5650 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5651 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5652 again.
5653
5654 Default is `grow-only'.
5655
5656 ** LessTif support.
5657
5658 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5659 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5660
5661 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5662
5663 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5664 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5665 non-nil.
5666
5667 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5668
5669 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5670 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5671 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5672
5673 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5674
5675 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5676 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5677 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5678 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5679 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5680 Emacs.
5681
5682 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5683 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5684 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5685 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5686 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5687 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5688
5689 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5690 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5691 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5692 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5693 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5694 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5695
5696 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5697 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5698 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5699 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5700 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5701
5702 ** Tool bar support.
5703
5704 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5705 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5706 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5707 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5708 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5709 icons will be used.
5710
5711 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5712 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5713
5714 ** Tooltips.
5715
5716 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5717 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5718 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5719
5720 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5721 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5722 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5723 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5724
5725 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5726
5727 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5728 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5729 customized.
5730
5731 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5732 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5733 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5734 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5735 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5736
5737 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5738 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5739 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5740 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5741 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5742 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5743
5744 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5745 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5746 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5747 customizing face `fringe'.
5748
5749 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5750 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5751 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5752 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5753 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5754 the window to be partially obscured.)
5755
5756 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5757 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5758 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5759 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5760
5761 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5762
5763 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5764 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5765 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5766 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5767 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5768 have enabled one.
5769
5770 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5771
5772 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5773
5774 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5775
5776 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5777 `*') toggles the status.
5778
5779 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5780
5781 ** Hourglass pointer
5782
5783 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5784 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5785
5786 ** Blinking cursor
5787
5788 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5789 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5790 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5791 the group `cursor'.
5792
5793 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5794
5795 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5796 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5797 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5798 details.
5799
5800 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5801 have to do anything to activate it.
5802
5803 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5804
5805 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5806 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5807
5808 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5809 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5810 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5811 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5812 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5813 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5814 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5815 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5816
5817 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5818 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5819 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5820 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5821 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5822 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5823
5824 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5825 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5826
5827 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5828 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5829 buffer by default.
5830
5831 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5832 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5833 beginning and end of the buffer.
5834
5835 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5836 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5837 signaled.
5838
5839 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5840 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5841
5842 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5843 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5844 this behavior.
5845
5846 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5847 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5848 Emacs dump core.
5849
5850 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5851
5852 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5853 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5854 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5855
5856 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5857 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5858 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5859
5860 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5861 using that menu.
5862
5863 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5864
5865 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5866 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5867 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5868 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5869 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5870 whitespace.
5871
5872 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5873 all frames except the selected one.
5874
5875 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5876 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5877
5878 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5879 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5880 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5881 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5882 `Info-use-header-line'.
5883
5884 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5885 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5886 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5887
5888 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5889
5890 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5891 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5892 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5893
5894 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5895 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5896 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5897 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5898
5899 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5900
5901 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5902 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5903 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5904 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5905
5906 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5907 point in a pop-up window.
5908
5909 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5910 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5911 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5912
5913 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5914 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5915
5916 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5917 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5918 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5919 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5920
5921 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5922
5923 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5924 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5925
5926 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5927 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5928 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5929
5930 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5931 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5932 non-nil.
5933
5934 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5935 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5936 file that is already visited under a different name.
5937
5938 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5939 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5940
5941 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5942 and displays information about that.
5943
5944 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5945 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5946
5947 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5948 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5949 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5950 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5951 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5952 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5953
5954 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5955 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5956
5957 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5958 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5959 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5960 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5961 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5962 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5963 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5964
5965 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5966 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5967
5968 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5969 system for keyboard input.
5970
5971 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5972 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5973 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5974 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5975 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5976 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5977 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5978 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5979 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5980
5981 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5982 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5983
5984 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5985 displays all characters in that character set.
5986
5987 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5988 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5989
5990 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5991 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5992 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5993
5994 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5995 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5996 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5997 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5998 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5999 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
6000 and Polish `slash'.
6001
6002 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
6003 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
6004 of the tutorial.
6005
6006 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
6007 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
6008 Lisp Coding Convention".
6009
6010 new command old-binding
6011 --- ------- -----------
6012 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
6013 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
6014 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
6015
6016 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
6017 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
6018 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
6019
6020 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
6021 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
6022 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
6023 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
6024 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
6025 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
6026
6027 ** There are new Leim input methods.
6028 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
6029 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
6030 package.
6031
6032 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
6033 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
6034 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
6035 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
6036 "`", you must type "=q".
6037
6038 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6039 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6040 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6041 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6042 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6043 on.
6044
6045 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6046 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6047 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6048 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6049
6050 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6051 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6052 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6053 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6054
6055 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6056 on the display using several methods
6057
6058 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6059 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6060 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6061
6062 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6063 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6064
6065 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6066
6067 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6068 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6069
6070 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6071 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6072 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6073 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6074
6075 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6076 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6077 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6078
6079 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6080 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6081
6082 ** New X resources recognized
6083
6084 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6085 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6086 is useful for debugging X problems.
6087
6088 Example:
6089
6090 emacs.synchronous: true
6091
6092 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6093 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6094 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6095 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6096 visual class names are
6097
6098 TrueColor
6099 PseudoColor
6100 DirectColor
6101 StaticColor
6102 GrayScale
6103 StaticGray
6104
6105 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6106 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6107 meaning.
6108
6109 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6110 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6111 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6112 visual.
6113
6114 Example:
6115
6116 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6117
6118 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6119 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6120 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6121 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6122
6123 Example:
6124
6125 emacs.privateColormap: true
6126
6127 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6128
6129 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6130 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6131 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6132 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6133 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6134 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6135 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6136
6137 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6138 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6139 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6140 `default' face and vice versa.
6141
6142 ** New face `menu'.
6143
6144 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6145
6146 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6147
6148 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6149 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6150 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6151 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6152
6153 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6154 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6155 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6156
6157 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6158 `ScreenGamma'.
6159
6160 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6161
6162 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6163 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6164 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6165 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6166
6167 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6168
6169 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6170
6171 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6172
6173 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6174 LessTif/Motif one.
6175
6176 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6177 LessTif and Motif.
6178
6179 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6180
6181 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6182 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6183 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6184
6185 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6186 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6187
6188 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6189 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6190 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6191
6192 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6193
6194 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6195 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6196 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6197 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6198
6199 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6200 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6201 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6202 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6203
6204 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6205 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6206 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6207 buffers.
6208
6209 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6210
6211 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6212 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6213 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6214
6215 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6216 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6217 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6218 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6219 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6220 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6221
6222 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6223
6224 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6225 notably at the end of lines.
6226
6227 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6228 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6229
6230 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6231
6232 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6233 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6234
6235 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6236 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6237 after each match to get the replacement text.
6238
6239 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6240 you edit the replacement string.
6241
6242 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6243 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6244 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6245
6246 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6247
6248 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6249 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6250
6251 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6252 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6253 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6254 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6255
6256 --
6257 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6258 read mail from the menu etc.
6259
6260 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6261 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6262 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6263 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6264
6265 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6266 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6267
6268 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6269 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6270 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6271 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6272 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6273 of Emacs.
6274
6275 ** Customize changes
6276
6277 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6278 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6279 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6280 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6281 earlier versions of Emacs.
6282
6283 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6284 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6285 default).
6286
6287 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6288 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6289 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6290 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6291 file.
6292
6293 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6294 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6295 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6296 already in your init file.
6297
6298 ** New features in evaluation commands
6299
6300 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6301 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6302 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6303 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6304 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6305
6306 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6307 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6308 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6309 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6310 printed).
6311
6312 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6313 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6314
6315 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6316 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6317
6318 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6319 code when called with a prefix argument.
6320
6321 ** CC mode changes.
6322
6323 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6324 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6325 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6326 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6327 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6328 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6329 release.
6330
6331 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6332 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6333 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6334 confusion.
6335
6336 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6337 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6338 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6339 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6340
6341 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6342 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6343
6344 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6345 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6346
6347 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6348 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6349 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6350 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6351
6352 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6353 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6354 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6355 earlier statement. An example:
6356
6357 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6358 if (a[i])
6359 res += a[i]->offset;
6360 else
6361
6362 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6363 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6364 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6365 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6366 the preceding "if".
6367
6368 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6369 by default.
6370
6371 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6372 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6373 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6374 documentation or other natural language text.
6375
6376 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6377 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6378 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6379 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6380 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6381 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6382 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6383
6384 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6385 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6386 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6387 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6388
6389 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6390 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6391 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6392 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6393 Pike mode only.
6394
6395 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6396 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6397 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6398 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6399 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6400 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6401 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6402 is reported afterwards.
6403
6404 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6405 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6406 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6407
6408 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6409 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6410 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6411 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6412 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6413 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6414 groundwork.
6415
6416 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6417 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6418 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6419 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6420 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6421 have to bother.
6422
6423 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6424 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6425 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6426 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6427 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6428 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6429
6430 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6431 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6432 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6433 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6434 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6435 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6436 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6437 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6438
6439 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6440 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6441 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6442 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6443 above.
6444
6445 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6446 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6447 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6448 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6449 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6450 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6451 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6452 function documentation for more info.
6453
6454 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6455 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6456 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6457 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6458 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6459 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6460 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6461 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6462
6463 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6464
6465 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6466 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6467
6468 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6469 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6470 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6471 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6472 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6473 style system.
6474
6475 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6476 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6477 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6478 as far as possible.
6479
6480 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6481 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6482 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6483 chapter about this in the manual.
6484
6485 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6486 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6487 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6488 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6489 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6490
6491 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6492 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6493 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6494
6495 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6496 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6497
6498 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6499 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6500 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6501 inside CC Mode.
6502
6503 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6504 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6505 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6506 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6507 cc-mode/).
6508
6509 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6510 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6511 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6512 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6513 they were before the filling.
6514
6515 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6516 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6517 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6518 literals.
6519
6520 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6521 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6522 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6523 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6524 this function.
6525
6526 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6527 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6528 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6529 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6530 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6531
6532 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6533 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6534 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6535
6536 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6537
6538 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6539 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6540 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6541 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6542
6543 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6544 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6545 the column specified by comment-column.
6546
6547 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6548 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6549 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6550 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6551 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6552 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6553
6554 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6555 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6556 arguments.
6557
6558 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6559
6560 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6561 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6562 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6563 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6564 Provan).
6565
6566 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6567
6568 ** Dired changes
6569
6570 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6571 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6572 is, delete only empty directories.
6573
6574 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6575 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6576 copy directories recursively.
6577
6578 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6579 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6580 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6581
6582 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6583 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6584 directory.
6585
6586 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6587 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6588 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6589 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6590 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6591
6592 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6593 from ls switches.
6594
6595 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6596 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6597 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6598 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6599
6600 ** Gnus changes.
6601
6602 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6603 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6604 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6605
6606 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6607 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6608
6609 If you used procmail like in
6610
6611 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6612 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6613 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6614 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6615
6616 this now has changed to
6617
6618 (setq mail-sources
6619 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6620 :suffix ".in")))
6621
6622 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6623 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6624
6625 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6626 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6627 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6628 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6629
6630 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6631 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6632 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6633
6634 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6635 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6636 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6637 now just a compatibility layer.
6638
6639 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6640 Gnus facilities.
6641
6642 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6643 called to position point.
6644
6645 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6646 summary buffers and NOV files.
6647
6648 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6649 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6650
6651 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6652 subtly different manner.
6653
6654 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6655 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6656 ever-changing layouts.
6657
6658 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6659
6660 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6661
6662 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6663
6664 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6665 macros
6666
6667 Key binding Macro
6668 -------------------------
6669 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6670 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6671 C-c C-c u @uref
6672 C-c C-c q @quotation
6673 C-c C-c m @email
6674 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6675 M-RET @item
6676
6677 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6678
6679 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6680
6681 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6682 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6683 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6684
6685 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6686
6687 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6688 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6689 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6690 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6691 buffers to kill, as before.
6692
6693 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6694 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6695 this way.
6696
6697 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6698 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6699
6700 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6701
6702 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6703 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6704 use. Default is 1000.
6705
6706 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6707 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6708
6709 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6710
6711 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6712
6713 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6714 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6715 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6716 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6717
6718 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6719 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6720 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6721 the open block.
6722
6723 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6724 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6725 the normal block-hiding function.
6726
6727 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6728
6729 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6730 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6731 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6732 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6733
6734 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6735 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6736
6737 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6738
6739 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6740 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6741 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6742
6743 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6744 current buffer.
6745
6746 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6747 in a log file.
6748
6749 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6750 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6751 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6752 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6753 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6754 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6755
6756 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6757
6758 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6759
6760 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6761 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6762
6763 ** Changes in Font Lock
6764
6765 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6766 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6767
6768 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6769 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6770
6771 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6772 the face used for each string/comment.
6773
6774 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6775 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6776
6777 ** Changes to Shell mode
6778
6779 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6780 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6781 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6782 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6783
6784 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6785
6786 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6787 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6788
6789 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6790 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6791 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6792 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6793 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6794 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6795
6796 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6797 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6798 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6799 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6800 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6801 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6802 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6803 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6804
6805 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6806 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6807
6808 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6809 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6810 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6811
6812 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6813 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6814 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6815
6816 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6817 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6818 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6819
6820 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6821 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6822 argument, it appends to the file.
6823
6824 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6825 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6826 compatibility.
6827
6828 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6829 ring (history).
6830
6831 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6832 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6833 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6834
6835 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6836
6837 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6838 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6839 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6840 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6841 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6842 as correspondent.
6843
6844 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6845 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6846 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6847
6848 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6849 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6850 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6851 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6852 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6853
6854 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6855 like `j'.
6856
6857 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6858 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6859 digest message.
6860
6861 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6862 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6863
6864 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6865 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6866 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6867
6868 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6869 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6870
6871 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6872 use the -f option when sending mail.
6873
6874 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6875 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6876 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6877 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6878 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6879 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6880
6881 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6882 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6883 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6884
6885 ** Changes to TeX mode
6886
6887 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6888 `latex-mode'.
6889
6890 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6891
6892 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6893
6894 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6895
6896 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6897
6898 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6899 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6900 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6901 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6902 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6903 can be edited from that buffer.
6904
6905 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6906 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6907 `A' to use all marked entries).
6908
6909 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6910 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6911
6912 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6913 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6914 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6915 been cited.
6916
6917 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6918 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6919 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6920 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6921
6922 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6923 has the following new features:
6924
6925 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6926 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6927 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6928 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6929
6930 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6931 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6932 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6933 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6934 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6935 defaults to 1.
6936
6937 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6938 file names.
6939
6940 ** Ispell changes
6941
6942 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6943 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6944 spell-checks the current buffer.
6945
6946 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6947 added.
6948
6949 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6950 correction is made and re-checked.
6951
6952 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6953
6954 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6955 cases.
6956
6957 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6958 on syntax errors.
6959
6960 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6961 end of the buffer.
6962
6963 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6964
6965 ** Makefile mode changes
6966
6967 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6968
6969 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6970 Fontlock mode is active.
6971
6972 ** Isearch changes
6973
6974 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6975 so that searches can be resumed.
6976
6977 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6978 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6979 that started the search.
6980
6981 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6982 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6983
6984 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6985
6986 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6987 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6988 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6989 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6990 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6991 `secondary-selection'.
6992
6993 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6994 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6995 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6996 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6997 usual snappy response.
6998
6999 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
7000 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
7001 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
7002 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
7003
7004 ** VC Changes
7005
7006 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
7007 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
7008 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
7009 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
7010 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
7011 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
7012 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
7013 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
7014 file is registered in that backend.
7015
7016 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
7017 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
7018 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
7019 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
7020 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
7021 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
7022
7023 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
7024 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
7025 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
7026 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
7027 where it doesn't make sense.)
7028
7029 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
7030 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
7031 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
7032
7033 *** General Changes
7034
7035 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
7036 checks are always done now.
7037
7038 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7039 operations.
7040
7041 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7042 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7043 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7044
7045 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7046 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7047 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7048 the working file (``merge news'').
7049
7050 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7051 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7052 downwards.
7053
7054 *** Multiple Backends
7055
7056 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7057 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7058 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7059 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7060 local RCS archives.
7061
7062 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7063 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7064 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7065 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7066
7067 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7068 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7069 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7070 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7071 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7072
7073 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7074 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7075 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7076 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7077
7078 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7079 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7080 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7081 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7082
7083 *** Changes for CVS
7084
7085 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7086 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7087 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7088 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7089 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7090 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7091 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7092
7093 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7094 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7095 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7096 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7097 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7098 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7099 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7100 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7101 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7102 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7103 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7104 name.)
7105
7106 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7107 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7108 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7109 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7110 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7111 entire directory tree.
7112
7113 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7114 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7115 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7116 "watched" by other developers.)
7117
7118 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7119 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7120 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7121 starting at the given directory.
7122
7123 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7124
7125 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7126 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7127 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7128 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7129 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7130 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7131 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7132 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7133 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7134
7135 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7136 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7137 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7138 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7139
7140 ** New modes and packages
7141
7142 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7143 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7144 the default is not applicable.
7145
7146 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7147 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7148 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7149
7150 Features are:
7151
7152 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7153 drawn, like this: | \ /
7154 --+-- X
7155 | / \
7156
7157 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7158 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7159 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7160 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7161 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7162 you are drawing.
7163
7164 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7165 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7166
7167 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7168 flood-filling.
7169
7170 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7171 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7172 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7173 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7174
7175 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7176 also do without the mouse.
7177
7178 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7179 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7180 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7181 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7182 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7183
7184 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7185
7186 lines straight-lines
7187 rectangles squares
7188 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7189 ellipses circles
7190 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7191 spray-can setting size for spraying
7192 vaporize line vaporize lines
7193 erase characters erase rectangles
7194
7195 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7196 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7197 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7198 drawing.
7199
7200 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7201 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7202 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7203 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7204
7205 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7206 can be turned off).
7207
7208 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7209 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7210 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7211 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7212 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7213 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7214 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7215 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7216 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7217
7218 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7219 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7220 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7221 on certain projects.
7222
7223 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7224 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7225
7226 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7227
7228 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7229 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7230 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7231 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7232 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7233 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7234 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7235 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7236
7237 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7238 Emacs is idle.
7239
7240 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7241 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7242
7243 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7244 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7245
7246 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7247 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7248 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7249 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7250 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7251
7252 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7253 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7254 separate Texinfo file.
7255
7256 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7257 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7258 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7259 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7260 enter check-in log messages.
7261
7262 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7263 without invoking external programs.
7264
7265 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7266 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7267 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7268 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7269 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7270
7271 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7272 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7273
7274 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7275 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7276
7277 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7278 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7279 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7280 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7281 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7282 single step.
7283
7284 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7285 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7286 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7287 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7288
7289 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7290 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7291 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7292
7293 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7294 PostScript.
7295
7296 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7297
7298 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7299
7300 ; comment (until end of line)
7301 A non-terminal
7302 "C" terminal
7303 ?C? special
7304 $A default non-terminal
7305 $"C" default terminal
7306 $?C? default special
7307 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7308 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7309 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7310 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7311 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7312 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7313 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7314 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7315 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7316 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7317 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7318 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7319 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7320 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7321 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7322
7323 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7324
7325 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7326 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7327 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7328 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7329 equal signs of assignments.
7330
7331 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7332 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7333
7334 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7335 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7336 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7337
7338 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7339
7340 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7341 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7342 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7343 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7344 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7345 which answers different needs.
7346
7347 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7348 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7349 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7350 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7351 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7352 to be enabled.
7353
7354 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7355 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7356
7357 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7358
7359 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7360 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7361 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7362
7363 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7364
7365 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7366 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7367 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7368 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7369 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7370 and background colors.
7371
7372 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7373 Pascal) language.
7374
7375 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7376 the text at point.
7377
7378 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7379
7380 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7381
7382 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7383 whitespace in a file.
7384
7385 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7386 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7387 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7388 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7389 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7390 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7391 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7392
7393 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7394
7395 Here is an example of columns:
7396
7397 horse apple bus
7398 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7399 porcupine strawberry airplane
7400
7401 Doing the following settings:
7402
7403 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7404 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7405 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7406 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7407
7408
7409 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7410
7411 M-x delimit-columns-region
7412
7413 It results:
7414
7415 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7416 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7417 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7418
7419 delim-col has the following options:
7420
7421 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7422 before all columns.
7423
7424 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7425 between each column.
7426
7427 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7428 after all columns.
7429
7430 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7431 each column.
7432
7433 delim-col has the following commands:
7434
7435 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7436 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7437
7438 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7439 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7440 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7441 recent file list can be displayed:
7442
7443 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7444 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7445 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7446
7447 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7448 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7449
7450 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7451 text.
7452
7453 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7454 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7455 specific to Message mode.
7456
7457 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7458 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7459 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7460
7461 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7462 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7463 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7464
7465 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7466 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7467
7468 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7469
7470 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7471 minibuffer with completion.
7472
7473 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7474 with the diary features.
7475
7476 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7477 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7478
7479 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7480 Fill mode.
7481
7482 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7483 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7484 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7485 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7486
7487 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7488 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7489 `.g'.
7490
7491 ** Changes in sort.el
7492
7493 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7494 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7495 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7496 numeric base.
7497
7498 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7499
7500 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7501 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7502 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7503
7504 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7505 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7506
7507 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7508 output ^M at the end of lines.
7509
7510 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7511 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7512
7513 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7514 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7515 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7516
7517 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7518 group.
7519
7520 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7521 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7522 are recognized:
7523
7524 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7525 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7526 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7527 nil -- just delete one character.
7528
7529 Default value is `untabify'.
7530
7531 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7532
7533 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7534 symbol, not double-quoted.
7535
7536 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7537 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7538 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7539 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7540
7541 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7542 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7543 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7544
7545 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7546 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7547 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7548
7549 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7550 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7551
7552 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7553 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7554
7555 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7556 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7557
7558 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7559 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7560 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7561 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7562 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7563 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7564
7565 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7566 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7567
7568 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7569
7570 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7571 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7572
7573 ** Shell script mode changes.
7574
7575 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7576 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7577 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7578
7579 ** Etags changes.
7580
7581 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7582
7583 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7584 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7585 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7586 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7587 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7588
7589 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7590 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7591
7592 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7593 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7594
7595 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7596 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7597 `template' keywords.
7598
7599 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7600 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7601
7602 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7603 types.
7604
7605 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7606
7607 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7608
7609 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7610 are now tagged.
7611
7612 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7613
7614 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7615 variables are tagged.
7616
7617 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7618
7619 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7620 for PSWrap.
7621
7622 ** Changes in etags.el
7623
7624 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7625 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7626 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7627
7628 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7629 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7630
7631 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7632 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7633 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7634 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7635
7636 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7637
7638 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7639 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7640
7641 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7642
7643 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7644 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7645 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7646
7647 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7648 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7649
7650 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7651 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7652
7653 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7654 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7655 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7656 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7657 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7658
7659 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7660 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7661 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7662
7663 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7664 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7665 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7666
7667 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7668 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7669 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7670
7671 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7672
7673 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7674
7675 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7676 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7677 expression from that list, are not checked.
7678
7679 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7680 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7681 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7682 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7683
7684 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7685
7686 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7687 displays local abbrevs, only.
7688
7689 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7690 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7691
7692 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7693 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7694 is measured in pixels.
7695
7696 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7697 to be visited as images.
7698
7699 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7700 were added to compile.el.
7701
7702 ** Withdrawn packages
7703
7704 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7705 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7706
7707 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7708
7709 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7710
7711 \f
7712 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7713
7714 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7715 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7716 See the sections below for details.
7717
7718 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7719 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7720 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7721 to remove the properties of the copy.
7722
7723 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7724 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7725 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7726 these properties are active.
7727
7728 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7729 ranges may affect some code.
7730
7731 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7732 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7733 make a difference to some code.
7734
7735 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7736 operates on the minibuffer.
7737
7738 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7739 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7740 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7741 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7742 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7743 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7744 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7745 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7746 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7747 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7748 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7749 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7750
7751 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7752 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7753 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7754
7755 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7756 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7757 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7758
7759 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7760 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7761 such as `mapconcat'.
7762
7763 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7764 string.
7765
7766 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7767 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7768 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7769 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7770 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7771 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7772 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7773 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7774
7775 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7776 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7777 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7778 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7779 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7780 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7781 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7782 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7783 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7784 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7785
7786 \f
7787 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7788 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7789
7790 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7791
7792 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7793 allows the animated display of strings.
7794
7795 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7796 interactive form of a function.
7797
7798 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7799 between custom options. Example:
7800
7801 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7802 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7803 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7804 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7805 :group 'mule
7806 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7807 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7808
7809 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7810 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7811 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7812
7813 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7814 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7815 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7816 (signal or normal termination).
7817
7818 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7819 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7820
7821 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7822 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7823
7824 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7825 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7826
7827 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7828
7829 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7830 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7831 being deleted.
7832
7833 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7834
7835 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7836 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7837 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7838 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7839 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7840 charset.
7841
7842 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7843 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7844 message.
7845
7846 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7847 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7848
7849 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7850 with the more general `:mask' property.
7851
7852 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7853
7854 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7855 backslash.
7856
7857 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7858 is running in batch mode. For example,
7859
7860 (message "%s" (read t))
7861
7862 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7863 to standard output.
7864
7865 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7866 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7867
7868 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7869 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7870 frame or window.
7871
7872 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7873 were added
7874
7875 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7876
7877 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7878 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7879
7880 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7881
7882 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7883 comparison is done with `eq'.
7884
7885 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7886
7887 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7888 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7889 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7890
7891 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7892 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7893 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7894
7895 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7896 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7897
7898 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7899 function was declared obsolete.
7900
7901 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7902 retained as an alias).
7903
7904 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7905 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7906
7907 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7908
7909 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7910
7911 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7912 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7913 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7914 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7915 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7916 means never include the minibuffer window.
7917
7918 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7919
7920 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7921
7922 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7923
7924 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7925 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7926 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7927 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7928 returned.
7929
7930 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7931 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7932 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7933 minibuffer even if it is active.
7934
7935 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7936 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7937 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7938 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7939 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7940 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7941
7942 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7943 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7944 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7945 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7946 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7947 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7948 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7949
7950 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7951 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7952 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7953
7954 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7955 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7956 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7957 Default value is nil.
7958
7959 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7960 meaning no limit.
7961
7962 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7963 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7964 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7965
7966 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7967 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7968 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7969
7970 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7971 list of a primitive.
7972
7973 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7974
7975 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7976 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7977 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7978 than replacing the local map.
7979
7980 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7981 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7982 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7983 instead.
7984
7985 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7986
7987 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7988 as promised long ago.
7989
7990 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7991
7992 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7993 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7994 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7995
7996 \f
7997 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7998
7999 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
8000 regular expressions.
8001
8002 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
8003
8004 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8005
8006 - Macro: rx SEXP
8007
8008 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8009
8010 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
8011 notation.
8012
8013 STRING
8014 matches string STRING literally.
8015
8016 CHAR
8017 matches character CHAR literally.
8018
8019 `not-newline'
8020 matches any character except a newline.
8021 .
8022 `anything'
8023 matches any character
8024
8025 `(any SET)'
8026 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
8027 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
8028
8029 '(in SET)'
8030 like `any'.
8031
8032 `(not (any SET))'
8033 matches any character not in SET
8034
8035 `line-start'
8036 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
8037 in the text being matched
8038
8039 `line-end'
8040 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8041
8042 `string-start'
8043 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8044 string being matched against.
8045
8046 `string-end'
8047 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8048 string being matched against.
8049
8050 `buffer-start'
8051 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8052 buffer being matched against.
8053
8054 `buffer-end'
8055 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8056 buffer being matched against.
8057
8058 `point'
8059 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8060
8061 `word-start'
8062 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8063 word.
8064
8065 `word-end'
8066 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8067
8068 `word-boundary'
8069 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8070 word.
8071
8072 `(not word-boundary)'
8073 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8074 word.
8075
8076 `digit'
8077 matches 0 through 9.
8078
8079 `control'
8080 matches ASCII control characters.
8081
8082 `hex-digit'
8083 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8084
8085 `blank'
8086 matches space and tab only.
8087
8088 `graphic'
8089 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8090 space, and DEL.
8091
8092 `printing'
8093 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8094 and DEL.
8095
8096 `alphanumeric'
8097 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8098 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8099
8100 `letter'
8101 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8102 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8103
8104 `ascii'
8105 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8106
8107 `nonascii'
8108 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8109
8110 `lower'
8111 matches anything lower-case.
8112
8113 `upper'
8114 matches anything upper-case.
8115
8116 `punctuation'
8117 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8118 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8119
8120 `space'
8121 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8122
8123 `word'
8124 matches anything that has word syntax.
8125
8126 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8127 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8128 of the following symbols.
8129
8130 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8131 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8132 `word' (\\sw)
8133 `symbol' (\\s_)
8134 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8135 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8136 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8137 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8138 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8139 `escape' (\\s\\)
8140 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8141 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8142 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8143
8144 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8145 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8146
8147 `(category CATEGORY)'
8148 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8149 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8150
8151 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8152 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8153 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8154 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8155 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8156 `symbol' (\\c5)
8157 `digit' (\\c6)
8158 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8159 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8160 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8161 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8162 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8163 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8164 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8165 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8166 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8167 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8168 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8169 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8170 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8171 `ascii' (\\ca)
8172 `arabic' (\\cb)
8173 `chinese' (\\cc)
8174 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8175 `greek' (\\cg)
8176 `korean' (\\ch)
8177 `indian' (\\ci)
8178 `japanese' (\\cj)
8179 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8180 `latin' (\\cl)
8181 `lao' (\\co)
8182 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8183 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8184 `thai' (\\ct)
8185 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8186 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8187 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8188 `can-break' (\\c|)
8189
8190 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8191 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8192
8193 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8194 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8195
8196 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8197 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8198 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8199
8200 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8201 another name for `submatch'.
8202
8203 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8204 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8205 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8206 regular expression.
8207
8208 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8209 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8210 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8211 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8212 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8213
8214 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8215 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8216
8217 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8218 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8219
8220 `(0+ SEXP)'
8221 like `zero-or-more'.
8222
8223 `(* SEXP)'
8224 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8225
8226 `(*? SEXP)'
8227 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8228
8229 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8230 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8231
8232 `(1+ SEXP)'
8233 like `one-or-more'.
8234
8235 `(+ SEXP)'
8236 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8237
8238 `(+? SEXP)'
8239 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8240
8241 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8242 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8243
8244 `(optional SEXP)'
8245 like `zero-or-one'.
8246
8247 `(? SEXP)'
8248 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8249
8250 `(?? SEXP)'
8251 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8252
8253 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8254 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8255
8256 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8257 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8258
8259 `(eval FORM)'
8260 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8261 `regexp-quote' it.
8262
8263 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8264 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8265
8266 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8267
8268 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8269 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8270 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8271 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8272
8273 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8274 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8275 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8276 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8277
8278 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8279 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8280 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8281
8282 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8283 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8284 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8285 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8286 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8287 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8288 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8289 eight-bit-graphic.
8290
8291 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8292
8293 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8294 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8295 character set as previously.
8296
8297 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8298 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8299 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8300
8301 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8302 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8303 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8304 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8305
8306 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8307 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8308
8309 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8310 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8311 "fontset-default".
8312
8313 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8314 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8315
8316 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8317 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8318 buffers and strings.
8319
8320 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8321 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8322 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8323 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8324 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8325 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8326 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8327 also been deleted.
8328
8329 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8330 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8331 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8332
8333 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8334 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8335 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8336 may differ between buffer and string text.
8337
8338 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8339 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8340
8341 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8342 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8343 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8344 `composition' from STRING.
8345
8346 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8347 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8348
8349 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8350 obsolete.
8351
8352 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8353 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8354
8355 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8356 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8357 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8358 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8359
8360 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8361 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8362 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8363 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8364 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8365 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8366
8367 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8368 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8369 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8370
8371 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8372 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8373 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8374
8375 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8376 have been introduced.
8377
8378 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8379 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8380 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8381 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8382 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8383 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8384 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8385 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8386 their multibyte equivalent.
8387
8388 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8389 that offset in the file before writing.
8390
8391 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8392 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8393
8394 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8395 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8396 from which the command was issued.
8397
8398 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8399 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8400 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8401 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8402 operate on.
8403
8404 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8405 to `window-buffer-height'.
8406
8407 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8408
8409 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8410 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8411 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8412
8413 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8414 respectively.
8415
8416 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8417 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8418
8419 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8420 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8421 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8422
8423 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8424 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8425 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8426 is currently displayed in some window.
8427
8428 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8429 argument function's results.
8430
8431 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8432 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8433 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8434 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8435 sequence).
8436
8437 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8438 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8439
8440 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8441 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8442
8443 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8444 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8445 as follows:
8446
8447 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8448 nil don't display a cursor
8449 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8450 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8451 others display a box cursor.
8452
8453 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8454 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8455 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8456 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8457
8458 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8459 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8460 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8461 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8462
8463 Example:
8464
8465 (string-to-syntax "()")
8466 => (4 . 41)
8467
8468 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8469 other than 10.
8470
8471 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8472 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8473
8474 #b1111
8475 => 15
8476 #b-1111
8477 => -15
8478
8479 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8480
8481 #o666
8482 => 438
8483
8484 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8485
8486 #xbeef
8487 => 48815
8488
8489 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8490
8491 #2R-111
8492 => -7
8493 #25rah
8494 => 267
8495
8496 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8497 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8498 and isn't a string.
8499
8500 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8501 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8502 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8503 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8504
8505 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8506
8507 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8508 for a regexp in a string.
8509
8510 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8511 `mouse-position-function'.
8512
8513 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8514 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8515
8516 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8517 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8518
8519 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8520 returns it.
8521
8522 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8523 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8524
8525 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8526 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8527 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8528 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8529 mode.
8530
8531 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8532 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8533
8534 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8535 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8536 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8537 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8538 been performed."
8539
8540 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8541 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8542 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8543 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8544
8545 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8546 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8547 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8548
8549 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8550 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8551 specified table.
8552
8553 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8554
8555 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8556 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8557 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8558 what BODY returns.
8559
8560 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8561 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8562 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8563 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8564 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8565
8566 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8567 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8568
8569 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8570 instead of being optional.
8571
8572 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8573 modify read-only text.
8574
8575 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8576
8577 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8578 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8579 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8580 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8581 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8582
8583 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8584 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8585 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8586 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8587 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8588 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8589 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8590
8591 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8592 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8593 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8594 start sequences.
8595
8596 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8597 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8598
8599 ** New function `propertize'
8600
8601 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8602 strings with text properties.
8603
8604 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8605
8606 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8607 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8608 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8609 specified value of that property. Example:
8610
8611 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8612
8613 ** push and pop macros.
8614
8615 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8616 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8617 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8618
8619 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8620 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8621 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8622
8623 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8624
8625 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8626 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8627
8628 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8629 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8630 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8631 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8632
8633 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8634 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8635 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8636 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8637
8638 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8639 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8640 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8641 or a sign.
8642
8643 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8644 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8645 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8646 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8647 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8648 space, and DEL.
8649 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8650 and DEL.
8651 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8652 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8653 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8654 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8655 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8656 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8657 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8658 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8659 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8660 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8661 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8662 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8663 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8664 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8665 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8666
8667 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8668
8669 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8670
8671 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8672
8673 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8674 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8675
8676 :test TEST
8677
8678 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8679 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8680 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8681
8682 :size SIZE
8683
8684 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8685 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8686
8687 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8688
8689 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8690 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8691 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8692 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8693 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8694
8695 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8696
8697 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8698 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8699 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8700
8701 :weakness WEAK
8702
8703 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8704 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8705 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8706 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8707 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8708
8709 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8710
8711 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8712
8713 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8714
8715 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8716
8717 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8718
8719 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8720 values are shared.
8721
8722 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8723
8724 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8725
8726 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8727
8728 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8729
8730 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8731
8732 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8733
8734 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8735
8736 Returns the size of TABLE.
8737
8738 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8739
8740 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8741
8742 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8743
8744 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8745
8746 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8747
8748 Clear TABLE.
8749
8750 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8751
8752 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8753 not found.
8754
8755 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8756
8757 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8758 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8759
8760 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8761
8762 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8763
8764 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8765
8766 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8767 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8768
8769 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8770
8771 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8772
8773 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8774
8775 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8776 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8777 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8778 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8779 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8780
8781 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8782
8783 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8784 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8785 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8786
8787 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8788 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8789
8790 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8791 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8792
8793 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8794 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8795
8796 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8797 'case-fold-string-hash))
8798
8799 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8800
8801 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8802
8803 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8804 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8805 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8806
8807 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8808
8809 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8810 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8811
8812 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8813 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8814 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8815 is too short to reach that column.
8816
8817 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8818 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8819 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8820 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8821
8822 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8823 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8824 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8825
8826 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8827 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8828
8829 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8830 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8831
8832 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8833 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8834 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8835 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8836 temporary-file-directory instead.
8837
8838 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8839 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8840 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8841 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8842
8843 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8844 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8845
8846 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8847
8848 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8849 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8850 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8851
8852 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8853
8854 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8855 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8856 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8857 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8858 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8859 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8860
8861 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8862 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8863 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8864 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8865
8866 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8867
8868 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8869 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8870 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8871 result string.
8872
8873 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8874 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8875
8876 Example:
8877
8878 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8879 (s2 "world"))
8880 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8881 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8882 (format s1 s2))
8883
8884 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8885
8886 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8887
8888 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8889 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8890 argument in it.
8891
8892 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8893 (arg "world"))
8894 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8895 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8896 (message msg arg))
8897
8898 ** Sound support
8899
8900 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8901 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8902
8903 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8904 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8905 to enable sound support.
8906
8907 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8908 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8909 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8910 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8911 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8912
8913 The following sound properties are supported:
8914
8915 - `:file FILE'
8916
8917 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8918 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8919
8920 - `:data DATA'
8921
8922 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8923 may be present, but not both.
8924
8925 - `:volume VOLUME'
8926
8927 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8928 0..1. This property is optional.
8929
8930 - `:device DEVICE'
8931
8932 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8933 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8934
8935 Other properties are ignored.
8936
8937 An alternative interface is called as
8938 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8939
8940 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8941
8942 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8943 a keyword symbol.
8944
8945 ** Changes to garbage collection
8946
8947 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8948 of live and free strings.
8949
8950 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8951 strings that have been consed so far.
8952
8953 \f
8954 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8955 Lisp Manual
8956
8957 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8958 mini-windows.
8959
8960 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8961 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8962 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8963
8964 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8965
8966 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8967
8968 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8969 image.
8970
8971 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8972
8973 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8974
8975 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8976 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8977 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8978 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8979 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8980
8981 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8982 has a mask bitmap.
8983
8984 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8985
8986 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8987 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8988 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8989
8990 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8991 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8992
8993 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8994 optional.
8995
8996 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8997 below).
8998
8999 \f
9000 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
9001
9002 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
9003 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
9004
9005 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
9006 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
9007 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
9008 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
9009 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
9010 just display it black instead.
9011
9012 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
9013 a line like
9014
9015 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
9016
9017 in your `.emacs'.
9018
9019 ** New face implementation.
9020
9021 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
9022 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
9023
9024 *** New faces.
9025
9026 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
9027
9028 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
9029
9030 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
9031 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
9032
9033 3. Font height in 1/10pt
9034
9035 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
9036
9037 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9038
9039 6. Foreground color.
9040
9041 7. Background color.
9042
9043 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9044
9045 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9046
9047 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9048
9049 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9050
9051 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9052 color.
9053
9054 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9055 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9056
9057 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9058 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9059 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9060 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9061 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9062 attributes mentioned above.
9063
9064 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9065 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9066 created frames.
9067
9068 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9069 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9070 `fully-specified'.
9071
9072 *** Face merging.
9073
9074 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9075 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9076 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9077 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9078 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9079 results in a fully-specified face.
9080
9081 *** Face realization.
9082
9083 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9084 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9085 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9086 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9087 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9088 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9089
9090 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9091 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9092 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9093 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9094
9095 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9096 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9097 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9098 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9099 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9100
9101 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9102 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9103 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9104 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9105 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9106 Emacs.
9107
9108 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9109 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9110 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9111 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9112
9113 **** Clearing face caches.
9114
9115 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9116 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9117 unused fonts.
9118
9119 *** Font selection.
9120
9121 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9122 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9123 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9124
9125 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9126 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9127 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9128 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9129 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9130
9131 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9132 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9133 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9134
9135 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9136
9137 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9138 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9139 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9140 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9141 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9142 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9143 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9144
9145 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9146 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9147 doesn't exist.
9148
9149 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9150 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9151 registry.
9152
9153 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9154 slightly different.
9155
9156 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9157
9158
9159 **** Scalable fonts
9160
9161 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9162 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9163 servers.
9164
9165 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9166 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9167 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9168 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9169 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9170 that list. Example:
9171
9172 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9173
9174 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9175
9176 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9177
9178 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9179
9180 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9181 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9182 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9183
9184 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9185 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9186 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9187 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9188 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9189 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9190 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9191 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9192 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9193 of the face font sort order.
9194
9195 - Function: x-font-family-list
9196
9197 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9198 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9199 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9200 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9201
9202 - Variable: font-list-limit
9203
9204 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9205 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9206 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9207
9208 *** Setting face attributes.
9209
9210 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9211 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9212 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9213 `face-attribute'.
9214
9215 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9216 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9217
9218 The following attributes are recognized:
9219
9220 `:family'
9221
9222 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9223 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9224 and `?' are allowed.
9225
9226 `:width'
9227
9228 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9229 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9230 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9231 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9232
9233 `:height'
9234
9235 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9236 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9237 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9238 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9239
9240 `:weight'
9241
9242 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9243 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9244 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9245
9246 `:slant'
9247
9248 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9249 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9250 `reverse-oblique'.
9251
9252 `:foreground', `:background'
9253
9254 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9255
9256 `:underline'
9257
9258 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9259 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9260 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9261 don't underline.
9262
9263 `:overline'
9264
9265 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9266 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9267 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9268 overline.
9269
9270 `:strike-through'
9271
9272 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9273 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9274 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9275 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9276
9277 `:box'
9278
9279 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9280 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9281 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9282 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9283 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9284 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9285 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9286 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9287 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9288 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9289 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9290 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9291 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9292 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9293 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9294 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9295 box.
9296
9297 `:inverse-video'
9298
9299 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9300 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9301
9302 `:stipple'
9303
9304 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9305 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9306 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9307 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9308 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9309 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9310
9311 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9312 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9313
9314 `:font'
9315
9316 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9317 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9318 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9319 versions of Emacs.
9320
9321 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9322 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9323 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9324
9325 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9326 `defface'.
9327
9328 `:inherit'
9329
9330 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9331 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9332 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9333
9334 *** Face attributes and X resources
9335
9336 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9337 from X resources:
9338
9339 Face attribute X resource class
9340 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9341 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9342 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9343 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9344 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9345 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9346 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9347 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9348 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9349 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9350 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9351 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9352 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9353 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9354 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9355 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9356 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9357 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9358 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9359 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9360
9361 *** Text property `face'.
9362
9363 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9364 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9365 specification can be
9366
9367 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9368
9369 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9370 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9371 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9372 for face attribute names.
9373
9374 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9375 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9376 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9377
9378 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9379
9380 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9381 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9382 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9383 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9384 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9385 used to clear the mapping table.
9386
9387 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9388
9389 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9390 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9391 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9392 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9393 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9394 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9395 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9396 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9397 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9398 modify their color-related behavior.
9399
9400 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9401 any frame type.
9402
9403 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9404
9405 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9406 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9407 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9408 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9409 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9410 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9411 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9412 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9413 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9414
9415 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9416 display can display image files.
9417
9418 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9419
9420 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9421 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9422 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9423 `Inviolable' option.
9424
9425 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9426 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9427 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9428
9429 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9430
9431 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9432 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9433 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9434
9435 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9436 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9437 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9438 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9439 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9440 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9441 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9442 functions.
9443
9444 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9445 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9446 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9447
9448 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9449
9450 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9451
9452 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9453
9454 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9455 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9456 constrained position if that is different.
9457
9458 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9459 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9460 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9461 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9462 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9463 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9464 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9465 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9466 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9467
9468 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9469 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9470 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9471 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9472 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9473
9474 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9475 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9476
9477 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9478
9479 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9480
9481 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9482 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9483 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9484
9485 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9486
9487 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9488 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9489 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9490 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9491 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9492
9493 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9494
9495 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9496 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9497 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9498 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9499 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9500
9501 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9502
9503 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9504 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9505 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9506
9507 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9508
9509 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9510 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9511 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9512
9513 ** Image support.
9514
9515 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9516 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9517 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9518 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9519
9520 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9521 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9522 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9523 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9524 area.
9525
9526 IMAGE is an image specification.
9527
9528 *** Image specifications
9529
9530 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9531 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9532 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9533 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9534 described below are ignored.
9535
9536 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9537
9538 `:ascent ASCENT'
9539
9540 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9541 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9542 to use for its ascent.
9543
9544 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9545 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9546
9547 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9548 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9549 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9550 overlays that apply to the image.
9551
9552 `:margin MARGIN'
9553
9554 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9555 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9556 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9557
9558 `:relief RELIEF'
9559
9560 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9561 around an image.
9562
9563 `:conversion ALGO'
9564
9565 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9566
9567 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9568 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9569
9570 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9571 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9572 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9573 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9574 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9575 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9576 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9577 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9578 below.
9579
9580 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9581 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9582 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9583
9584 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9585 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9586 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9587 of the factors' absolute values.
9588
9589 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9590
9591 (1 0 0
9592 0 0 0
9593 9 9 -1)
9594
9595 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9596
9597 ( 2 -1 0
9598 -1 0 1
9599 0 1 -2)
9600
9601 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9602 ``disabled''.
9603
9604 `:mask MASK'
9605
9606 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9607 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9608 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9609 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9610 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9611 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9612 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9613 image.
9614
9615 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9616 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9617 `:mask nil'.
9618
9619 `:file FILE'
9620
9621 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9622 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9623 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9624 may be present in the image specification.
9625
9626 `:data DATA'
9627
9628 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9629 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9630 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9631 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9632
9633 *** Supported image types
9634
9635 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9636
9637 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9638 properties supported are:
9639
9640 `:foreground FG'
9641
9642 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9643 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9644
9645 `:background BG'
9646
9647 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9648 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9649
9650 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9651 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9652 instead of a `:file' property.
9653
9654 `:width WIDTH'
9655
9656 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9657
9658 `:height HEIGHT'
9659
9660 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9661
9662 `:data DATA'
9663
9664 DATA must be either
9665
9666 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9667 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9668
9669 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9670
9671 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9672 bitmap.
9673
9674 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9675 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9676 in the file.
9677
9678 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9679
9680 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9681 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9682 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9683 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9684
9685 Additional image properties supported are:
9686
9687 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9688
9689 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9690 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9691 name.
9692
9693 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9694 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9695
9696 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9697 to display compressed images.
9698
9699 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9700
9701 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9702 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9703 mono images are:
9704
9705 `:foreground FG'
9706
9707 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9708 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9709
9710 `:background FG'
9711
9712 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9713 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9714
9715 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9716
9717 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9718 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9719 properties defined.
9720
9721 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9722
9723 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9724 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9725 properties defined.
9726
9727 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9728
9729 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9730 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9731
9732 Additional image properties supported are:
9733
9734 `:index INDEX'
9735
9736 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9737 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9738 as a hollow box.
9739
9740 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9741 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9742 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9743 every 0.1 seconds.
9744
9745 (defun show-anim (file max)
9746 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9747 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9748
9749 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9750 (when (= idx max)
9751 (setq idx 0))
9752 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9753 (save-excursion
9754 (set-buffer buffer)
9755 (goto-char (point-min))
9756 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9757 (insert-image img "x"))
9758 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9759
9760 **** PNG, image type `png'
9761
9762 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9763 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9764 properties defined.
9765
9766 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9767
9768 Additional image properties supported are:
9769
9770 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9771
9772 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9773 integer. This is a required property.
9774
9775 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9776
9777 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9778 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9779
9780 `:bounding-box BOX'
9781
9782 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9783 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9784 files. This is an required property.
9785
9786 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9787 lisp/gs.el.
9788
9789 *** Lisp interface.
9790
9791 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9792 which are supported in the current configuration.
9793
9794 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9795 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9796 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9797 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9798 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9799
9800 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9801
9802 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9803 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9804 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9805 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9806 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9807 buffer.
9808
9809 ** Display margins.
9810
9811 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9812 and images.
9813
9814 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9815 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9816 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9817 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9818 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9819 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9820 of the display margins.
9821
9822 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9823 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9824 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9825 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9826 in this file).
9827
9828 ** Help display
9829
9830 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9831 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9832 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9833 that have a `help-echo' property.
9834
9835 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9836 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9837 the window in which the help was found.
9838
9839 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9840 `help-echo' text property was found.
9841
9842 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9843 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9844
9845 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9846 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9847 mouse.
9848
9849 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9850 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9851
9852 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9853 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9854 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9855 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9856 used as help string.
9857
9858 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9859 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9860 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9861
9862 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9863
9864 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9865 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9866
9867 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9868 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9869 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9870 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9871 used.
9872
9873 (global-set-key [A-down]
9874 #'(lambda ()
9875 (interactive)
9876 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9877 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9878 (global-set-key [A-up]
9879 #'(lambda ()
9880 (interactive)
9881 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9882 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9883
9884 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9885
9886 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9887 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9888 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9889 is called with one argument, POS.
9890
9891 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9892 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9893 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9894 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9895 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9896
9897 ** Tool bar support.
9898
9899 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9900 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9901 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9902 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9903 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9904 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9905
9906 *** Tool bar item definitions
9907
9908 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9909 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9910 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9911
9912 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9913 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9914 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9915 property (see below).
9916
9917 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9918 binding are currently ignored.
9919
9920 The following properties are recognized:
9921
9922 `:enable FORM'.
9923
9924 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9925 or disabled.
9926
9927 `:visible FORM'
9928
9929 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9930
9931 `:filter FUNCTION'
9932
9933 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9934 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9935 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9936
9937 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9938
9939 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9940 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9941
9942 `:image IMAGES'
9943
9944 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9945 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9946 meaning of each of the four elements:
9947
9948 Index Use when item is
9949 ----------------------------------------
9950 0 enabled and selected
9951 1 enabled and deselected
9952 2 disabled and selected
9953 3 disabled and deselected
9954
9955 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9956 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9957
9958 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9959
9960 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9961 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9962
9963 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9964 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9965 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9966 menu bar.
9967
9968 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9969 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9970 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9971
9972 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9973
9974 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9975 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9976 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9977
9978 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9979 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9980
9981 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9982 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9983 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9984 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9985
9986 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9987 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9988
9989 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9990
9991 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9992 a tool bar item. If
9993
9994 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9995 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9996 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9997
9998 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9999
10000 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
10001
10002 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
10003 item.
10004
10005 ** Mode line changes.
10006
10007 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
10008
10009 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
10010 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
10011 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
10012
10013 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
10014 a `local-map' text property.
10015
10016 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
10017 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
10018
10019 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
10020 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
10021 `local-map' property.
10022
10023 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
10024 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
10025 example.
10026
10027 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
10028 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
10029
10030 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
10031 variable mode-line-format to nil.
10032
10033 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
10034
10035 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
10036 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
10037 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10038 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10039 line.
10040
10041 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10042 `header-line'.
10043
10044 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10045 position in the header-line.
10046
10047 ** Text property `display'
10048
10049 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10050 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10051 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10052 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10053 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10054
10055 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10056
10057 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10058 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10059
10060 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10061 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10062 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10063 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10064 simpler form STRING as property value.
10065
10066 *** Variable width and height spaces
10067
10068 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10069 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10070 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10071 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10072 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10073 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10074 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10075
10076 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10077 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10078 properties described below.
10079
10080 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10081 characters having the `display' property.
10082
10083 - :width WIDTH
10084
10085 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10086 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10087
10088 - :relative-width FACTOR
10089
10090 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10091 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10092 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10093 width of that character by FACTOR.
10094
10095 - :align-to HPOS
10096
10097 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10098 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10099
10100 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10101
10102 - :height HEIGHT
10103
10104 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10105 normal line height.
10106
10107 - :relative-height FACTOR
10108
10109 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10110 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10111
10112 - :ascent ASCENT
10113
10114 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10115 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10116 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10117 equal to 100.
10118
10119 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10120
10121 *** Images
10122
10123 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10124 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10125 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10126 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10127 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10128 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10129 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10130 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10131 as display specification.
10132
10133 *** Other display properties
10134
10135 - (space-width FACTOR)
10136
10137 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10138 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10139 integer or float.
10140
10141 - (height HEIGHT)
10142
10143 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10144
10145 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10146 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10147 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10148 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10149 a font is available counts as a step.
10150
10151 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10152 as tall as the frame's default font.
10153
10154 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10155 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10156
10157 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10158 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10159
10160 - (raise FACTOR)
10161
10162 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10163 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10164 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10165 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10166 `height' subproperty.
10167
10168 *** Conditional display properties
10169
10170 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10171 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10172 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10173 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10174 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10175 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10176 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10177 different when object is a string.
10178
10179 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10180 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10181
10182 ** New menu separator types.
10183
10184 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10185 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10186 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10187 to specify other menu separator types.
10188
10189 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10190
10191 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10192 separator occurs.
10193
10194 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10195
10196 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10197
10198 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10199
10200 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10201
10202 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10203
10204 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10205
10206 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10207
10208 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10209
10210 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10211
10212 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10213 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10214
10215 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10216
10217 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10218
10219 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10220
10221 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10222
10223 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10224
10225 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10226
10227 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10228
10229 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10230
10231 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10232
10233 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10234
10235 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10236
10237 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10238
10239 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10240
10241 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10242
10243 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10244 the corresponding single-line separators.
10245
10246 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10247
10248 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10249 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10250 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10251 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10252 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10253 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10254 default foreground is black.
10255
10256 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10257 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10258 `ScrollBarBackground').
10259
10260 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10261 settings for scroll bar colors.
10262
10263 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10264 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10265
10266 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10267 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10268 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10269 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10270 the original window start.
10271
10272 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10273 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10274 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10275
10276 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10277
10278 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10279 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10280 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10281 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10282
10283 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10284 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10285
10286 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10287
10288 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10289 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10290 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10291 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10292 temporarily to nil, for example
10293
10294 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10295 (enlarge-window 10))
10296
10297 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10298 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10299
10300 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10301 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10302 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10303 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10304 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10305 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10306
10307
10308 \f
10309 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10310
10311 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10312 input.
10313
10314 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10315
10316 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10317
10318 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10319 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10320 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10321 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10322 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10323
10324 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10325 been added.
10326
10327 \f
10328 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10329
10330 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10331
10332
10333 \f
10334 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10335
10336 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10337 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10338 \f
10339 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10340
10341 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10342
10343 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10344 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10345 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10346
10347 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10348 is the one that is used.
10349
10350 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10351 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10352 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10353 separate from the command's regular output.
10354 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10355 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10356 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10357 the buffer name.
10358
10359 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10360 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10361 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10362 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10363
10364 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10365 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10366 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10367 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10368
10369 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10370 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10371 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10372 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10373
10374 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10375 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10376 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10377 they never ignore case.
10378
10379 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10380 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10381 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10382 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10383 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10384 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10385 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10386
10387 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10388 the same format that was used in the file before.
10389
10390 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10391 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10392
10393 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10394 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10395 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10396
10397 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10398 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10399 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10400 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10401 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10402 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10403 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10404
10405 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10406 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10407 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10408 format. You can now customize these variables.
10409
10410 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10411 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10412 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10413 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10414
10415 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10416 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10417 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10418
10419 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10420 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10421 doesn't have any effect.
10422
10423 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10424 not one per buffer.
10425
10426 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10427 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10428 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10429
10430 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10431 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10432 `auto-show-mode' command.
10433
10434 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10435 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10436 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10437 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10438 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10439
10440 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10441 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10442
10443 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10444 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10445 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10446
10447 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10448 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10449 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10450 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10451
10452 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10453
10454 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10455 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10456 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10457 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10458 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10459
10460 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10461 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10462
10463 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10464 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10465 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10466 `?' on other systems.
10467
10468 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10469 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10470 Unix.
10471
10472 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10473 current codepage when it starts.
10474
10475 ** Mail changes
10476
10477 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10478 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10479 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10480 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10481 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10482 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10483 latin-1:
10484
10485 MIME-version: 1.0
10486 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10487 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10488
10489 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10490 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10491 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10492 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10493 buffer-file-coding-system.
10494
10495 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10496 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10497 mail.
10498
10499 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10500 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10501 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10502 list of possible coding systems.
10503
10504 ** CC Mode changes
10505
10506 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10507 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10508 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10509 docstring for details.
10510
10511 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10512 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10513 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10514 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10515 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10516
10517 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10518 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10519
10520 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10521 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10522
10523 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10524 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10525 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10526 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10527 anonymous classes.
10528
10529 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10530 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10531
10532 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10533 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10534 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10535 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10536
10537 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10538 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10539 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10540 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10541 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10542
10543 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10544
10545 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10546
10547 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10548 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10549
10550 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10551
10552 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10553 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10554 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10555 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10556 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10557
10558 ** Gnus changes.
10559
10560 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10561 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10562 Gnus manual for the full story.
10563
10564 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10565 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10566 group, which is created automatically.
10567
10568 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10569 values.
10570
10571 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10572
10573 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10574 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10575
10576 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10577 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10578
10579 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10580
10581 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10582 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10583
10584 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10585
10586 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10587 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10588
10589 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10590 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10591
10592 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10593 control over simplification.
10594
10595 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10596
10597 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10598 limit.
10599
10600 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10601
10602 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10603
10604 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10605 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10606 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10607
10608 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10609 `a' forces normal posting method.
10610
10611 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10612 -- `W d'.
10613
10614 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10615 to a non-nil value.
10616
10617 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10618 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10619
10620 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10621 has been added.
10622
10623 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10624
10625 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10626
10627 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10628 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10629
10630 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10631 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10632
10633 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10634
10635 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10636 been added.
10637
10638 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10639 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10640
10641 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10642 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10643
10644 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10645
10646 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10647
10648 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10649
10650 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10651
10652 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10653 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10654 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10655
10656 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10657 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10658 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10659 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10660 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10661
10662 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10663 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10664 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10665 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10666
10667 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10668 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10669 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10670 mismatch.
10671
10672 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10673
10674 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10675 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10676
10677 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10678 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10679 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10680 removed from the label.
10681
10682 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10683 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10684
10685 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10686 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10687
10688 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10689 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10690 expressions.
10691
10692 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10693
10694 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10695
10696 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10697 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10698
10699 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10700 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10701 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10702
10703 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10704 changes with a special face.
10705
10706 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10707 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10708 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10709 \f
10710 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10711
10712 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10713 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10714 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10715 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10716 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10717
10718 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10719 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10720 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10721
10722 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10723 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10724 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10725 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10726 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10727 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10728 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10729 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10730 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10731
10732 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10733 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10734 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10735 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10736 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10737 program.
10738
10739 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10740 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10741 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10742 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10743 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10744 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10745
10746 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10747 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10748 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10749 was not documented clearly before.
10750
10751 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10752 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10753 \f
10754 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10755
10756 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10757 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10758 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10759 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10760
10761 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10762 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10763 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10764
10765 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10766
10767 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10768 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10769
10770 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10771 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10772 integers.
10773
10774 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10775 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10776 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10777 file names and attributes are returned.
10778
10779 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10780 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10781 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10782 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10783 returns the result.
10784
10785 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10786 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10787
10788 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10789
10790 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10791 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10792 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10793 optionally.
10794
10795 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10796 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10797
10798 **
10799 The new function process-running-child-p
10800 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10801 terminal to its own child process.
10802
10803 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10804 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10805 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10806 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10807
10808 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10809 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10810
10811 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10812 :included is an alias for :visible.
10813
10814 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10815 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10816 to move or copy menu entries.
10817
10818 ** Multibyte editing changes
10819
10820 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10821 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10822 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10823 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10824 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10825 (setq char (sref str idx)
10826 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10827 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10828
10829 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10830 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10831 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10832
10833 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10834 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10835 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10836
10837 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10838
10839 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10840 across the boundary.
10841
10842 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10843 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10844 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10845 contains 8-bit characters.
10846 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10847 contains invalid characters.
10848
10849 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10850 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10851 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10852 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10853 way.
10854
10855 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10856 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10857 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10858 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10859
10860 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10861 compose Thai characters in a string.
10862
10863 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10864 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10865 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10866 menus should always use the third argument.
10867
10868 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10869 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10870 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10871 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10872
10873 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10874 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10875 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10876 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10877
10878 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10879 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10880 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10881 echo area contents.
10882
10883 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10884
10885 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10886 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10887 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10888
10889 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10890 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10891 means to clear out that attribute.
10892
10893 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10894 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10895
10896 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10897 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10898 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10899 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10900
10901 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10902 the gap of the current buffer.
10903
10904 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10905 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10906 current buffer.
10907
10908 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10909 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10910 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10911 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10912 \f
10913 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10914
10915 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10916 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10917 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10918 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10919 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10920
10921 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10922 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10923 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10924 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10925 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10926
10927 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10928 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10929 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10930
10931 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10932 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10933 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10934 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10935 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10936 results.
10937
10938 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10939 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10940 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10941 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10942 \f
10943 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10944
10945 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10946 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10947 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10948 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10949
10950 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10951 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10952 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10953 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10954 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10955 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10956 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10957 region.
10958
10959 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10960 selective undo.
10961
10962 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10963 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10964 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10965 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10966 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10967
10968 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10969 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10970 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10971 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10972
10973 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10974 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10975 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10976 something that most users not do.
10977
10978 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10979 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10980 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10981 applications.
10982
10983 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10984 pasting operations.
10985
10986 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10987 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10988 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10989 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10990 `ps-printer-name'.
10991
10992 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10993 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10994 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10995 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10996 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10997 hits a new word.
10998
10999 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
11000 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
11001 to be confused by TeX commands.
11002
11003 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
11004 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
11005 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
11006 of various alternative replacements and actions.
11007
11008 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
11009 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
11010 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
11011 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
11012 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
11013
11014 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
11015 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
11016
11017 ** Changes in input method usage.
11018
11019 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
11020 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
11021 respectively.
11022
11023 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
11024
11025 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
11026 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
11027
11028 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
11029 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
11030
11031 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
11032
11033 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
11034
11035 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
11036 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
11037
11038 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11039 given in the following case:
11040 o When you are using a complex input method.
11041 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11042
11043 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11044 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11045 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11046 setting it to t is helpful.
11047
11048 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11049
11050 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11051 keys:
11052 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11053 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11054 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11055 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11056 environment.
11057
11058 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11059 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11060 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11061 get
11062
11063 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11064
11065 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11066
11067 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11068 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11069
11070 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11071 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11072 its owner and group.
11073
11074 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11075 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11076
11077 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11078 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11079
11080 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11081 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11082 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11083 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11084
11085 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11086 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11087 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11088 for writing keyboard macros.
11089
11090 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11091 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11092 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11093 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11094 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11095 info.
11096
11097 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11098
11099 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11100 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11101 contents only.
11102
11103 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11104 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11105 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11106 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11107
11108 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11109 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11110 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11111
11112 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11113 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11114 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11115 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11116
11117 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11118 failure if the command produces no output.
11119
11120 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11121 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11122 the mouse.
11123
11124 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11125 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11126 function and variable names.
11127
11128 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11129 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11130 file-coding-system-alist.
11131
11132 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11133 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11134 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11135 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11136 according to the current fontset.
11137
11138 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11139
11140 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11141 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11142 nonascii-insert-offset.
11143
11144 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11145 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11146 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11147 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11148
11149 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11150 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11151
11152 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11153 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11154
11155 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11156 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11157 command keys.
11158
11159 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11160 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11161
11162 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11163 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11164 all variables that have documentation.
11165
11166 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11167 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11168 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11169 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11170 it should show; the default is 20.
11171
11172 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11173 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11174 of your input.
11175
11176 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11177 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11178 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11179 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11180 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11181 Newly added options are included as well.
11182
11183 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11184 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11185 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11186
11187 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11188 Customize menu.
11189
11190 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11191 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11192
11193 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11194 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11195 invoked.
11196
11197 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11198 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11199 The default is 1.
11200
11201 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11202 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11203 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11204 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11205 sensibly.
11206
11207 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11208
11209 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11210 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11211 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11212
11213 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11214 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11215 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11216 every night.
11217
11218 ** Desktop changes
11219
11220 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11221 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11222
11223 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11224 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11225
11226 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11227 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11228
11229 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11230 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11231 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11232 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11233 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11234 made invisible again.
11235
11236 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11237
11238 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11239 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11240 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11241 toggle.
11242
11243 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11244 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11245 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11246 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11247 rmail-default-body-file.
11248
11249 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11250 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11251 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11252
11253 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11254 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11255 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11256
11257 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11258 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11259 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11260 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11261 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11262 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11263
11264 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11265 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11266 provided by feedmail are:
11267
11268 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11269 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11270 there is also a queue for draft messages
11271
11272 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11273 be prompted for confirmation
11274
11275 **** does smart filling of address headers
11276
11277 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11278 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11279 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11280
11281 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11282 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11283 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11284 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11285
11286 ** Dired changes
11287
11288 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11289 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11290
11291 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11292 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11293
11294 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11295 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11296 for a specified regexp.
11297
11298 ** VC Changes
11299
11300 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11301 conveniently.
11302
11303 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11304 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11305 Dired.
11306
11307 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11308 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11309 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11310 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11311
11312 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11313 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11314 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11315 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11316 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11317
11318 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11319 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11320 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11321 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11322 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11323
11324 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11325 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11326 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11327 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11328
11329 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11330 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11331 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11332
11333 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11334 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11335 session to resolve them.
11336
11337 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11338 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11339 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11340 uses as well).
11341
11342 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11343 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11344 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11345 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11346 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11347 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11348 using ediff.
11349
11350 ** Changes in Font Lock
11351
11352 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11353 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11354 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11355 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11356 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11357
11358 ** Frame name display changes
11359
11360 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11361 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11362 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11363 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11364
11365 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11366 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11367 menu.
11368
11369 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11370
11371 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11372 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11373 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11374
11375 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11376
11377 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11378 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11379 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11380
11381 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11382 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11383 the following line.
11384
11385 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11386 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11387 previously sent input.
11388
11389 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11390 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11391 as the search string.
11392
11393 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11394 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11395
11396 ** C mode changes
11397
11398 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11399 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11400 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11401 definition.
11402
11403 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11404 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11405 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11406 style is still the default however.
11407
11408 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11409
11410 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11411 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11412 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11413
11414 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11415 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11416
11417 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11418 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11419
11420 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11421 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11422
11423 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11424 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11425
11426 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11427 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11428 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11429 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11430
11431 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11432
11433 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11434 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11435 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11436
11437 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11438 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11439 expanding dynamically.
11440
11441 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11442 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11443
11444 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11445 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11446 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11447 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11448
11449 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11450
11451 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11452
11453 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11454 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11455 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11456 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11457 against the first word in the title.
11458
11459 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11460 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11461 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11462 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11463 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11464 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11465
11466 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11467 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11468 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11469 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11470
11471 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11472
11473 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11474 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11475 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11476 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11477 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11478 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11479
11480 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11481 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11482
11483 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11484 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11485 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11486
11487 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11488 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11489
11490 ** Ispell changes.
11491
11492 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11493 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11494 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11495
11496 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11497 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11498 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11499 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11500 include:
11501
11502 o URLs are automatically skipped
11503 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11504
11505 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11506
11507 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11508
11509 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11510 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11511 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11512 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11513
11514 *** New recursive parser.
11515
11516 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11517 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11518 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11519
11520 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11521
11522 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11523 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11524 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11525
11526 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11527
11528 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11529
11530 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11531
11532 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11533
11534 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11535
11536 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11537 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11538
11539 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11540
11541 *** References to external documents.
11542
11543 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11544 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11545 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11546 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11547 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11548 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11549 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11550
11551 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11552
11553 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11554 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11555
11556 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11557 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11558
11559 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11560
11561 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11562 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11563
11564 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11565
11566 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11567 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11568 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11569 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11570 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11571 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11572 more.
11573
11574 *** Support for the varioref package
11575
11576 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11577
11578 *** New hooks
11579
11580 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11581 and citations are created. These hooks are
11582 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11583 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11584
11585 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11586
11587 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11588 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11589
11590 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11591
11592 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11593 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11594 fontified, use
11595
11596 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11597
11598 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11599 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11600 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11601 directories that contain the same file name.
11602
11603 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11604 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11605 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11606 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11607 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11608 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11609 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11610 directory.
11611
11612 ** New modes and packages
11613
11614 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11615 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11616 it, but some do not.
11617
11618 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11619 code.
11620
11621 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11622 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11623 around in a buffer.
11624
11625 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11626
11627 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11628 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11629 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11630 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11631
11632 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11633 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11634 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11635
11636 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11637 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11638 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc.); others are implementations of
11639 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11640 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11641 the like.
11642
11643 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11644 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11645
11646 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11647 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11648 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11649 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11650
11651 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11652
11653 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11654 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11655 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11656 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11657 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc.)
11658 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11659 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11660 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11661 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11662 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11663 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11664
11665 Platform-specific modes:
11666
11667 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11668 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11669 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11670 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11671 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11672 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11673 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11674 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11675 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11676 \f
11677 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11678
11679 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11680 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11681 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11682 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11683
11684 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11685 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11686 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11687
11688 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11689 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11690 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11691 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11692
11693 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11694 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11695 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11696 environment.
11697
11698 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11699 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11700 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11701 current input method for reading this one event.
11702
11703 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11704 now control whether to output certain characters as
11705 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11706 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11707 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11708 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11709 \f
11710 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11711
11712 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11713 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11714
11715 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11716 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11717 always increases point by 1.
11718
11719 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11720 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11721
11722 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11723
11724 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11725 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11726 default value changed. For example,
11727
11728 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11729 :type 'integer
11730 :group 'foo
11731 :version "20.3")
11732
11733 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11734 :version "20.3")
11735
11736 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11737 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11738 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11739 `:version' in the top level group.
11740
11741 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11742
11743 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11744 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11745
11746 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11747 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11748 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11749 to themselves.
11750
11751 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11752 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11753 values whatever.
11754
11755 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11756 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11757 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11758
11759 ** Frame-local variables.
11760
11761 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11762 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11763 local bindings for that variable.
11764
11765 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11766 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11767 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11768 parameter name.
11769
11770 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11771 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11772 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11773 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11774
11775 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11776 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11777 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11778 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11779
11780 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11781 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11782 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11783 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11784 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11785
11786 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11787 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11788 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11789 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11790
11791 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11792 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11793
11794 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11795 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11796 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11797
11798 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11799 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11800 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11801 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11802
11803 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11804 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11805 empty input.
11806
11807 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11808 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11809 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11810 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11811 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11812
11813 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11814 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11815 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11816 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11817
11818 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11819 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11820 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11821 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11822 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11823
11824 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11825 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11826 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11827 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11828
11829 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11830 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11831 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11832
11833 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11834 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11835 was directed to display this buffer.
11836
11837 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11838 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11839 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11840 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11841 set-window-configuration.
11842
11843 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11844 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11845 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11846 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11847
11848 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11849 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11850 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11851
11852 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11853 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11854 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11855
11856 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11857 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11858
11859 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11860 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11861
11862 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11863 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11864 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11865
11866 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11867 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11868 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11869 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11870
11871 ** Menu changes
11872
11873 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11874 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11875 better supported.
11876
11877 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11878 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11879 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11880 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11881 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11882
11883 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11884
11885 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11886 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11887 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11888 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11889
11890 The format is:
11891 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11892 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11893 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11894 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11895 The supported properties include
11896
11897 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11898 item is enabled.
11899 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11900 item should appear in the menu.
11901 :filter FILTER-FN
11902 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11903 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11904 It should return a binding to use instead.
11905 :keys DESCRIPTION
11906 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11907 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11908 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11909 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11910 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11911 keyboard binding.
11912 :key-sequence nil
11913 This means that the command normally has no
11914 keyboard equivalent.
11915 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11916 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11917 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11918 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11919 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11920
11921 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11922 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11923
11924 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11925
11926 ** New event types
11927
11928 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11929 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11930 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11931 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11932
11933 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11934
11935 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11936 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11937 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11938 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11939 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11940 forward, away from the user.
11941
11942 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11943
11944 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11945 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11946 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11947 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11948 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11949
11950 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11951
11952 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11953 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11954 that were dragged and dropped.
11955
11956 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11957
11958 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11959
11960 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11961 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11962 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11963
11964 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11965 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11966 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11967
11968 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11969 in Emacs 19 and before.
11970
11971 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11972 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11973
11974 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11975 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11976 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11977 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11978
11979 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11980 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11981 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11982 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11983 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11984
11985 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11986 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11987 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11988 consistent with the new representation.
11989
11990 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11991 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11992 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11993 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11994
11995 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11996 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11997 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11998
11999 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
12000 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
12001 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12002
12003 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
12004 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
12005 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
12006
12007 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12008 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
12009
12010 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12011 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
12012
12013 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
12014 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
12015 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
12016 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
12017
12018 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
12019 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
12020
12021 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
12022 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
12023 buffer or string being searched.
12024
12025 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
12026 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
12027 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
12028 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
12029 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
12030 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
12031 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
12032
12033 *** Structure of coding system changed.
12034
12035 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
12036 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
12037 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12038 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12039 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12040 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12041 define-coding-system-alias.
12042
12043 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12044 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12045 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12046 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12047 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12048 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12049 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12050 `iso-8859-1'.
12051
12052 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12053 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12054 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12055 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12056
12057 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12058 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12059 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12060 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12061
12062 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12063 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12064 This function requires a user interaction.
12065
12066 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12067 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12068 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12069 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12070 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12071 select-safe-coding-system.
12072
12073 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12074 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12075 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12076 was done.
12077
12078 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12079 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12080 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12081
12082 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12083 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12084 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12085 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12086
12087 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12088 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12089 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12090 converted.
12091
12092 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12093 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12094
12095 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12096 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12097 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12098 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12099 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12100 range of characters.
12101
12102 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12103 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12104
12105 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12106 in the current buffer at position POS.
12107
12108 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12109 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12110 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12111 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12112 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12113 binding input-method-function to nil.
12114
12115 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12116 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12117 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12118 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12119 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12120
12121 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12122 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12123
12124 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12125 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12126
12127 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12128 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12129 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12130 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12131 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12132 \f
12133 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12134
12135 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12136 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12137 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12138 tree structure.
12139
12140 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12141 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12142
12143 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12144 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12145 in your .emacs file.)
12146
12147 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12148 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12149
12150 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12151 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12152
12153 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12154 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12155 kills the region.
12156
12157 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12158 delete the character before point, as usual.
12159
12160 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12161 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12162 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12163
12164 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12165 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12166 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12167 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12168 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12169 past.)
12170
12171 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12172 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12173 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12174 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12175 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12176
12177 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12178 and is an alias for it.
12179
12180 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12181 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12182
12183 ** Scrolling changes
12184
12185 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12186 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12187
12188 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12189 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12190 where it started.
12191
12192 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12193 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12194 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12195 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12196
12197 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12198 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12199 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12200 recenters the window.
12201
12202 ** International character set support (MULE)
12203
12204 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12205 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12206 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12207 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12208 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12209 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12210
12211 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12212 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12213 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12214 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12215 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12216
12217 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12218 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12219 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12220 language, to make it possible to type them.
12221
12222 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12223 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12224
12225 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12226 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12227
12228 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12229
12230 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12231
12232 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12233 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12234 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12235 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12236 characters for their work until they want to change.
12237
12238 *** Input methods
12239
12240 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12241 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12242 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12243 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12244 support several input methods.
12245
12246 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12247 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12248 work.
12249
12250 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12251 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12252 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12253 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12254 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12255 letter.
12256
12257 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12258 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12259 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12260 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12261 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12262
12263 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12264 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12265 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12266 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12267
12268 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12269 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12270 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12271 the first guess is wrong.
12272
12273 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12274 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12275
12276 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12277 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12278 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12279 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12280
12281 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12282 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12283 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12284 translate automatically to and from either one.
12285
12286 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12287
12288 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12289 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12290 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12291 what you want.
12292
12293 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12294 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12295 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12296 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12297
12298 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12299 character conversion as well.
12300
12301 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12302
12303 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12304 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12305 requires using many fonts.
12306
12307 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12308 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12309
12310 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12311 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12312 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12313 you would use a font.
12314
12315 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12316 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12317 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12318
12319 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12320 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12321 characters).
12322
12323 *** Defining fontsets.
12324
12325 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12326 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12327 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12328
12329 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12330 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12331 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12332 standard fontset are created automatically.
12333
12334 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12335 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12336 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12337 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12338 name is `fontset-startup'.
12339
12340 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12341 The resource value should have this form:
12342 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12343 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12344 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12345 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12346 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12347 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12348 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12349 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12350 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12351
12352 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12353 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12354 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12355
12356 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12357 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12358 following resource,
12359 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12360 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12361 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12362 Here is the substitution rule:
12363 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12364 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12365 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12366 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12367 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12368
12369 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12370 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12371 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12372
12373 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12374 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12375 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12376 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12377 fontsets.
12378
12379 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12380 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12381
12382 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12383 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12384 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12385 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12386 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12387 system for new files that you create.
12388
12389 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12390 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12391 whole Emacs session.
12392
12393 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12394 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12395 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12396
12397 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12398 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12399 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12400 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12401 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12402
12403 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12404 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12405 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12406 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12407 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12408
12409 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12410 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12411
12412 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12413 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12414
12415 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12416 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12417
12418 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12419 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12420 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12421 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12422 of the file.
12423
12424 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12425 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12426 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12427 translated into that character code.
12428
12429 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12430 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12431
12432 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12433
12434 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12435 the coding system for keyboard input.
12436
12437 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12438 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12439 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12440
12441 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12442
12443 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12444 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12445 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12446 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12447 designed to work with terminals.
12448
12449 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12450 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12451 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12452 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12453 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12454 in the corresponding buffer.
12455
12456 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12457
12458 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12459 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12460 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12461
12462 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12463 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12464 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12465 want to use.
12466
12467 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12468 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12469
12470 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12471 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12472 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12473 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12474
12475 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12476 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12477 related information.
12478
12479 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12480 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12481 scripts.
12482
12483 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12484 information about the support for a particular language.
12485 You specify the language as an argument.
12486
12487 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12488 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12489 first dash.
12490
12491 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12492 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12493 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12494 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12495
12496 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12497 B big5 (Chinese)
12498 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12499 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12500 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12501 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12502 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12503 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12504 K euc-korea (Korean)
12505 R koi8 (Russian)
12506 Q tibetan
12507 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12508 T lao
12509 T tis620 (Thai)
12510 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12511 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12512 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12513 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12514 z hz (Chinese)
12515
12516 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12517 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12518 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12519 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12520
12521 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12522 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12523
12524 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12525 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12526 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12527 Rmail files themselves.
12528
12529 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12530 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12531
12532 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12533 for sending mail:
12534
12535 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12536 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12537 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12538 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12539 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12540
12541 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12542 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12543 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12544 translations.
12545
12546 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12547 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12548 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12549 without any conversion.
12550
12551 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12552 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12553 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12554 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12555
12556 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12557 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12558
12559 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12560 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12561
12562 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12563 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12564
12565 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12566 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12567 in the buffer before point.
12568
12569 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12570 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12571 you are using.
12572
12573 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12574 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12575
12576 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12577
12578 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12579 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12580
12581 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12582 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12583 can become a bottleneck.
12584
12585 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12586 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12587 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12588 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12589 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12590 so useful that the change is worth while.
12591
12592 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12593 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12594 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12595 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12596
12597 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12598 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12599 show-paren-mode.
12600
12601 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12602 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12603 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12604
12605 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12606 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12607 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12608
12609 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12610 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12611 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12612
12613 ** Changes in View mode.
12614
12615 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12616 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12617
12618 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12619 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12620
12621 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12622 previous state.
12623
12624 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12625 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12626
12627 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12628 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12629 not just the selected window.
12630
12631 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12632 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12633 turns View mode on or off.
12634
12635 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12636 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12637 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12638
12639 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12640 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12641
12642 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12643 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12644 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12645 which version to compare with.
12646
12647 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12648 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12649
12650 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12651 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12652 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12653 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12654
12655 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12656 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12657 blocks, all of them or none.
12658
12659 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12660 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12661 confirmation first.
12662
12663 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12664 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12665 However, the mode will not be changed if
12666 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12667 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12668 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12669 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12670
12671 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12672
12673 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12674 these commands do not change the major mode.
12675
12676 ** M-x occur changes.
12677
12678 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12679 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12680
12681 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12682 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12683 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12684
12685 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12686 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12687 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12688 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12689 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12690
12691 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12692 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12693 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12694 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12695
12696 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12697 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12698 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12699
12700 ** Outline mode changes.
12701
12702 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12703
12704 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12705
12706 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12707 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12708 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12709 was already active.
12710
12711 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12712 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12713 get confused by it.
12714
12715 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12716 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12717
12718 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12719
12720 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12721 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12722 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12723 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12724
12725 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12726 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12727 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12728
12729 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12730 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12731 values.
12732
12733 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12734 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12735 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12736 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12737
12738 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12739 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12740 can be. The default value is 30.
12741
12742 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12743
12744 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12745 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12746 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12747 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12748 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12749 behavior.
12750
12751 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12752 compose-mail-other-frame.
12753
12754 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12755 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12756 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12757 buffer that shows the original message.
12758
12759 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12760 with separator lines around the contents.
12761
12762 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12763 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12764 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12765 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12766
12767 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12768
12769 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12770 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12771 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12772 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12773
12774 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12775 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12776 /etc/passwd.
12777
12778 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12779 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12780 /etc/passwd.
12781
12782 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12783 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12784 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12785 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12786
12787 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12788 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12789 be taken to be magic.
12790
12791 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12792 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12793 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12794
12795 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12796 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12797
12798 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12799 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12800
12801 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12802
12803 new key dired.el binding old key
12804 ------- ---------------- -------
12805 * c dired-change-marks c
12806 * m dired-mark m
12807 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12808 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12809 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12810 * u dired-unmark u
12811 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12812 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12813 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12814 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12815 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12816 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12817
12818 ** Rmail changes.
12819
12820 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12821 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12822 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12823 each time you run it.
12824
12825 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12826 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12827
12828 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12829 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12830 means to move in the opposite direction.
12831
12832 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12833 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12834
12835 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12836 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12837 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12838 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12839 for output.
12840
12841 ** Gnus changes.
12842
12843 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12844
12845 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12846 Gnus.
12847
12848 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12849 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12850
12851 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12852 article mode line.
12853
12854 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12855
12856 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12857
12858 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12859
12860 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12861 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12862 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12863
12864 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12865
12866 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12867
12868 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12869 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12870
12871 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12872 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12873 used to pick articles.
12874
12875 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12876 another have been added.
12877
12878 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12879
12880 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12881 generating lines in buffers.
12882
12883 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12884 `C-M-_'.
12885
12886 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12887
12888 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12889
12890 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12891
12892 *** Scores can be decayed.
12893
12894 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12895
12896 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12897 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12898
12899 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12900 the native server.
12901
12902 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12903
12904 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12905 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12906
12907 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12908
12909 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12910 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12911
12912 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12913 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12914
12915 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12916 a group.
12917
12918 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12919 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12920
12921 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12922
12923 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12924
12925 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12926
12927 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12928
12929 Use the `Y c' command.
12930
12931 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12932
12933 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12934
12935 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12936
12937 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12938 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12939
12940 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12941
12942 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12943
12944 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12945 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12946
12947 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12948
12949 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12950 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12951 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12952 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12953 this issue.)
12954
12955 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12956 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12957 particular news group. This can be done by:
12958
12959 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12960
12961 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12962 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12963 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12964 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12965 for reading and posting).
12966
12967 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12968 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12969 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12970 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12971 there.
12972
12973 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12974 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12975
12976 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12977 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12978 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12979 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12980 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12981
12982 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12983 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12984
12985 ** CC mode changes.
12986
12987 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12988 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12989 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12990 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12991 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12992 loaded.
12993
12994 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12995 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12996 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12997 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12998 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12999 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
13000
13001 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
13002 of the current buffer.
13003
13004 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
13005 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
13006 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
13007
13008 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
13009 style that the Python developers like.
13010
13011 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
13012 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
13013 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
13014
13015 ** VC Changes [new]
13016
13017 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
13018 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
13019 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
13020
13021 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
13022 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
13023 developers.
13024
13025 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
13026 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
13027
13028 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
13029 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
13030 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
13031 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
13032
13033 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
13034 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
13035
13036 ** Calendar changes.
13037
13038 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13039 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13040 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13041 following/previous years.
13042
13043 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13044 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13045 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13046 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13047 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13048 supposed attribute of God.
13049
13050 ** ps-print changes
13051
13052 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13053 layout.
13054
13055 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13056
13057 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13058 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13059 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13060 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13061
13062 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13063 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13064 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13065
13066 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13067 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13068
13069 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13070 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13071 printing for your printer.
13072
13073 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13074 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13075
13076 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13077 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13078
13079 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13080 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13081 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13082 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13083 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13084 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13085 The default value is nil.
13086
13087 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13088 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13089
13090 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13091 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13092 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13093 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13094 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13095 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13096 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13097
13098 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13099 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13100
13101 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13102 The default is 0 ("black").
13103
13104 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13105 The default is 0 ("black").
13106
13107 border-width Specify the border width.
13108 The default is 0.4.
13109
13110 Any other property is ignored.
13111
13112 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13113 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13114 documentation).
13115
13116 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13117 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13118 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13119 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13120 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13121 controlling headers.
13122
13123 *** Color management (subgroup)
13124
13125 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13126 color.
13127
13128 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13129
13130 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13131 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13132 background should be used. Valid values are:
13133
13134 t always use face background color.
13135 nil never use face background color.
13136 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13137
13138 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13139
13140 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13141 sheet of paper.
13142
13143 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13144 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13145
13146 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13147 each page.
13148
13149 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13150 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13151 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13152
13153 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13154 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13155 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13156
13157 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13158 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13159 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13160
13161 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13162 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13163 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13164
13165 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13166 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13167 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13168
13169 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13170
13171 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13172
13173 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13174 RGB color.
13175
13176 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13177 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13178 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13179
13180 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13181 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13182 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13183 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13184 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13185 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13186 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13187 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13188 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13189 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13190 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13191 10 + 10 +
13192 11 + 11 +
13193 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13194 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13195 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13196 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13197 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13198 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13199 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13200 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13201 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13202 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13203 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13204 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13205 22 + 22 +
13206 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13207
13208 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13209
13210
13211 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13212
13213 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13214 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13215 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13216 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13217 to "-P".
13218
13219 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13220 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13221 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13222
13223 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13224 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13225 do so.
13226
13227 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13228
13229 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13230 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13231 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13232 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13233 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13234 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13235 `setpagedevice'.
13236
13237 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13238 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13239 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13240
13241 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13242 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13243 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13244 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13245 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13246 its TO, are ignored.
13247
13248 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13249 pages. Valid values are:
13250
13251 nil print all pages.
13252
13253 `even-page' print only even pages.
13254
13255 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13256
13257 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13258 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13259 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13260 print only the even sheet of paper.
13261
13262 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13263 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13264 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13265 only the odd sheet of paper.
13266
13267 Any other value is treated as nil.
13268
13269 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13270 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13271 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13272
13273 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13274
13275 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13276 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13277
13278 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13279 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13280 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13281 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13282 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13283 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13284 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13285
13286 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13287 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13288 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13289 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13290 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13291 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13292 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13293
13294 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13295
13296 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13297 messages should be sent.
13298
13299 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13300 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13301 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13302
13303 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13304
13305 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13306 points for line numbers.
13307
13308 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13309 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13310
13311 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13312 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13313 to 2, the printing will look like:
13314
13315 1 one line
13316 one line
13317 3 one line
13318 one line
13319 5 one line
13320 one line
13321 ...
13322
13323 Valid values are:
13324
13325 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13326 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13327 is used.
13328
13329 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13330 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13331
13332 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13333
13334 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13335 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13336 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13337 3, the output will look like:
13338
13339 one line
13340 one line
13341 3 one line
13342 one line
13343 one line
13344 6 one line
13345 one line
13346 one line
13347 9 one line
13348 one line
13349 ...
13350
13351 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13352 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13353
13354 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13355 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13356 `ps-font-size').
13357
13358 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13359 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13360 `ps-font-size').
13361
13362 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13363
13364 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13365 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13366
13367 ** hideshow changes.
13368
13369 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13370 C++, ; for lisp).
13371
13372 *** Support for java-mode added.
13373
13374 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13375 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13376
13377 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13378 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13379 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13380
13381 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13382 robust and a lot faster.
13383
13384 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13385
13386 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13387 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13388 documentation for more details.
13389
13390 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13391
13392 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13393 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13394 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13395 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13396 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13397
13398 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13399 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13400 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13401 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13402
13403 ** Font Lock mode
13404
13405 *** Custom support
13406
13407 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13408 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13409 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13410 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13411 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13412 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13413
13414 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13415
13416 *** Maximum decoration
13417
13418 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13419 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13420 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13421 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13422 to get the old behavior.
13423
13424 *** New support
13425
13426 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13427
13428 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13429 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13430
13431 *** Configurable support
13432
13433 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13434 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13435 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13436 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13437 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13438 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13439 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13440
13441 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13442 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13443 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13444
13445 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13446
13447 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13448 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13449 for any mode.
13450
13451 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13452
13453 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13454
13455 in your ~/.emacs.
13456
13457 *** New faces
13458
13459 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13460 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13461 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13462 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13463
13464 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13465
13466 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13467 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13468 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13469
13470 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13471
13472 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13473 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13474 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13475 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13476 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13477 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13478 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13479
13480 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13481 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13482 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13483 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13484 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13485 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13486
13487 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13488
13489 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13490 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13491 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13492 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13493
13494 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13495 settings.
13496
13497 ** Ada mode changes.
13498
13499 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13500 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13501 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13502 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13503 stubs.
13504
13505 *** There are two new commands:
13506 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13507 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13508
13509 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13510 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13511 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13512
13513 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13514 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13515 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13516
13517 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13518 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13519 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13520 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13521
13522 ** Scheme mode changes.
13523
13524 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13525 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13526 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13527 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13528 have any effect.
13529
13530 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13531 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13532 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13533 variables as buffer-local variables.
13534
13535 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13536 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13537
13538 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13539
13540 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13541 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13542 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13543 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13544
13545 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13546 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13547 buffer in Emacs.
13548
13549 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13550 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13551 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13552 option takes precedence.
13553
13554 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13555 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13556 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13557
13558 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13559 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13560 the current defun.
13561
13562 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13563 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13564
13565 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13566 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13567 necessary).
13568
13569 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13570 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13571 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13572 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13573 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13574 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13575
13576 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13577 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13578 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13579 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13580
13581 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13582 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13583 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13584 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13585 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13586
13587 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13588 since it applies only to the current frame.
13589
13590 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13591 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13592 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13593
13594 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13595 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13596 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13597 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13598 instead of just the file you are editing.
13599
13600 ** RefTeX mode
13601
13602 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13603 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13604 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13605 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13606 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13607
13608 C-c ( reftex-label
13609 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13610 knows which kind of label is needed.
13611
13612 C-c ) reftex-reference
13613 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13614 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13615
13616 C-c [ reftex-citation
13617 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13618 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13619
13620 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13621 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13622
13623 C-c = reftex-toc
13624 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13625 can quickly jump to every section.
13626
13627 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13628 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13629 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13630 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13631 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13632
13633 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13634
13635 *** Info documentation is now available.
13636
13637 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13638 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13639
13640 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13641 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13642
13643 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13644 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13645
13646 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13647 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13648 appropriate functions.
13649
13650 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13651 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13652
13653 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13654 been cleaned.
13655
13656 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13657 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13658
13659 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13660 shall be delimited.
13661
13662 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13663 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13664 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13665
13666 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13667 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13668 prefixed with `ALT'.
13669
13670 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13671 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13672 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13673 documentation).
13674
13675 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13676 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13677 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13678
13679 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13680 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13681
13682 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13683 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13684 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13685
13686 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13687
13688 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13689
13690 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13691 from alien sources.
13692
13693 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13694 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13695 crossref entries.
13696
13697 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13698 region.
13699
13700 *** Added support for imenu.
13701
13702 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13703 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13704 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13705 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13706
13707 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13708 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13709
13710 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13711
13712 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13713
13714 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13715 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13716 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13717 as an argument.
13718
13719 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13720 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13721
13722 ** browse-url changes
13723
13724 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13725 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13726 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13727 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13728 customization variables.
13729
13730 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13731
13732 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13733 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13734 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13735
13736 ** Changes in Ediff
13737
13738 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13739 pops up the Info file for this command.
13740
13741 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13742 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13743 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13744 directories).
13745
13746 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13747 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13748 files in the same directory.
13749
13750 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13751 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13752 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13753
13754 ** Changes in Viper
13755
13756 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13757 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13758 instead of vip-.
13759 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13760 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13761 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13762 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13763 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13764 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13765 color when Viper is in insert state.
13766 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13767 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13768 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13769
13770 ** Etags changes.
13771
13772 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13773 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13774 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13775 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13776 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13777
13778 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13779
13780 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13781 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13782
13783 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13784 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13785 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13786
13787 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13788 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13789 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13790 methods and protocols.
13791
13792 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13793 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13794 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13795 paragraph name.
13796
13797 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13798 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13799 at least M times and as many as N times.
13800
13801 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13802 in files has changed slightly.
13803
13804 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13805 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13806 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13807 with old time-stamp-format values.
13808
13809 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13810 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13811 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13812 reasons.
13813
13814 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13815 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13816 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13817 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13818 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13819 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13820
13821 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13822 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13823 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13824
13825 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13826 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13827 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13828 recommended now will continue to work then.
13829
13830 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13831 details.
13832
13833 ** There are some additional major modes:
13834
13835 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13836 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13837 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13838
13839 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13840 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13841 into Emacs.
13842
13843 ** New Lisp packages include:
13844
13845 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13846
13847 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13848 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13849
13850 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13851
13852 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13853 in shell buffers.
13854
13855 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13856 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13857 and `elint-defun'.
13858
13859 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13860 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13861 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13862 strings or comments.
13863
13864 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13865 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13866 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13867 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13868 at these points.
13869
13870 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13871 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13872
13873 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13874 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13875
13876 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13877
13878 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13879 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13880
13881 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13882
13883 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13884
13885 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13886
13887 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13888 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13889
13890 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13891 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13892 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13893 original place after inserting the copy.
13894
13895 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13896 on the buffer.
13897
13898 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13899 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13900 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13901
13902 Enable mouse-drag with:
13903 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13904 -or-
13905 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13906
13907 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13908 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13909
13910 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13911 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13912
13913 *** ogonek
13914
13915 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13916 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13917 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13918 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13919 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13920 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13921 instance) and vice versa.
13922
13923 To use this package load it using
13924 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13925 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13926 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13927 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13928 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13929 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13930
13931 *** Interface to ph.
13932
13933 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13934
13935 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13936 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13937 these servers.
13938
13939 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13940
13941 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13942 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13943 while the real cursor does not move.
13944
13945 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13946 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13947
13948 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13949 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13950
13951 ** movemail change
13952
13953 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13954 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13955 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13956 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13957
13958 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13959 \f
13960 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13961
13962 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13963
13964 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13965 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13966 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13967 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13968 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13969
13970 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13971 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13972 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13973 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13974 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13975 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13976 \f
13977 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13978
13979 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13980 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13981 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13982 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13983
13984 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13985 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13986
13987 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13988 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13989 "win".
13990
13991 ** Basic Lisp changes
13992
13993 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13994 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13995
13996 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13997 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13998 or by the user.
13999
14000 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
14001
14002 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
14003
14004 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
14005 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
14006
14007 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
14008 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
14009 its argument.
14010
14011 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
14012
14013 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
14014
14015 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
14016
14017 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
14018 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
14019 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
14020 `format' function.
14021
14022 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
14023 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
14024 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
14025
14026 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
14027 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
14028 adding one of these suffixes.
14029
14030 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
14031 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
14032 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
14033
14034 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
14035 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
14036
14037 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14038
14039 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14040 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14041
14042 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14043 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14044
14045 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14046
14047 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14048 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14049
14050 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14051 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14052 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14053 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14054
14055 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14056 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14057 of the last form.
14058
14059 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14060 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14061 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14062 as the last form.
14063
14064 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14065 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14066 matches.
14067
14068 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14069
14070 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14071 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14072 Then it returns that string.
14073
14074 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14075
14076 (with-output-to-string
14077 (princ "The buffer is ")
14078 (princ (buffer-name)))
14079
14080 returns "The buffer is foo".
14081
14082 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14083 is non-nil.
14084
14085 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14086 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14087 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14088
14089 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14090 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14091
14092 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14093 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14094 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14095 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14096 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14097 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14098
14099 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14100 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14101 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14102 characters".
14103
14104 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14105 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14106 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14107 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14108 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14109
14110 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14111 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14112 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14113 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14114
14115 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14116 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14117
14118 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14119
14120 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14121 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14122 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14123 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14124 guaranteed.
14125
14126 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14127 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14128 character).
14129
14130 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14131
14132 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14133 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14134 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14135 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14136 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14137
14138 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14139
14140 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14141 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14142 more than the number of characters.
14143
14144 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14145 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14146 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14147 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14148 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14149 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14150
14151 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14152 and returns a string containing those characters.
14153
14154 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14155 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14156 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14157 character, sref signals an error.
14158
14159 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14160 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14161 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14162
14163 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14164 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14165 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14166
14167 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14168 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14169 to a vector of the characters in it.
14170
14171 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14172 of a string. You call it as follows:
14173
14174 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14175
14176 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14177 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14178 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14179 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14180 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14181
14182 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14183 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14184
14185 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14186 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14187
14188 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14189 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14190 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14191 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14192
14193 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14194
14195 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14196
14197 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14198 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14199 are not included in the resulting value.
14200
14201 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14202 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14203 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14204 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14205
14206 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14207 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14208 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14209 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14210 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14211 column START-COLUMN.
14212
14213 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14214 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14215 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14216 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14217 changed text, before the change.
14218
14219 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14220 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14221 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14222
14223 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14224
14225 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14226
14227 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14228 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14229
14230 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14231 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14232 which identify the character within that character set.
14233
14234 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14235 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14236 opposite of split-char.
14237
14238 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14239 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14240
14241 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14242 of all the characters in a string.
14243
14244 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14245 and specifying coding systems.
14246
14247 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14248 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14249 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14250 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14251 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14252 as what to do about code conversion.)
14253
14254 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14255 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14256
14257 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14258 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14259 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14260
14261 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14262 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14263 to match against a file name.
14264
14265 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14266 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14267 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14268 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14269 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14270 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14271
14272 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14273 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14274
14275 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14276 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14277
14278 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14279 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14280 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14281 service names.
14282
14283 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14284 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14285 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14286 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14287 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14288 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14289
14290 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14291 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14292
14293 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14294 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14295 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14296 start the subprocess.
14297
14298 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14299 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14300 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14301 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14302 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14303
14304 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14305 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14306 subprocess.
14307
14308 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14309 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14310 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14311 connection permanently or until overridden.
14312
14313 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14314 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14315 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14316 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14317 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14318 system for one operation at a time.
14319
14320 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14321 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14322
14323 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14324 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14325 The value is a cons cell,
14326 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14327 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14328 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14329 input to the subprocess.
14330
14331 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14332 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14333
14334 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14335 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14336 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14337
14338 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14339 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14340 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14341 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14342 customization.
14343
14344 Thus, instead of writing
14345
14346 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14347 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14348
14349 you would now write this:
14350
14351 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14352 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14353 :type 'boolean
14354 :group foo)
14355
14356 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14357 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14358 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14359 for a description of them.
14360
14361 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14362 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14363
14364 (defgroup ispell nil
14365 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14366 :group 'processes)
14367
14368 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14369 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14370 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14371 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14372 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14373
14374 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14375 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14376 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14377 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14378 first-level subgroups.
14379
14380 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14381
14382 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14383 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14384
14385 ** easy-mmode
14386
14387 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14388 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14389 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14390 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14391 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14392 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14393
14394 ** Text property changes
14395
14396 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14397 text property.
14398
14399 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14400 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14401 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14402 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14403 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14404
14405 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14406 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14407 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14408 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14409
14410 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14411 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14412 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14413
14414 ** Changes in invisibility features
14415
14416 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14417 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14418 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14419 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14420 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14421 make the overlay visible.
14422
14423 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14424 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14425 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14426 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14427 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14428 t when it should hide it.
14429
14430 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14431
14432 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14433 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14434 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14435 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14436 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14437 Here is an example of how to do this:
14438
14439 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14440 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14441 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14442 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14443
14444 ...
14445 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14446
14447 ...
14448 ;; When done with the overlays:
14449 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14450 ;; Or respectively:
14451 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14452
14453 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14454
14455 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14456 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14457 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14458 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14459
14460 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14461 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14462 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14463
14464 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14465 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14466
14467 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14468 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14469
14470 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14471 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14472 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14473
14474 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14475 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14476 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14477 determine the syntax type of the character.
14478
14479 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14480 of the current buffer.
14481
14482 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14483 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14484 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14485
14486 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14487 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14488 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14489 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14490 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14491
14492 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14493 text property.
14494
14495 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14496 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14497 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14498
14499 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14500 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14501 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14502 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14503 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14504
14505 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14506 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14507 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14508
14509 ** Changes in face features
14510
14511 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14512 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14513
14514 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14515 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14516
14517 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14518 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14519
14520 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14521 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14522
14523 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14524 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14525 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14526 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14527 overlay property).
14528
14529 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14530 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14531
14532 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14533
14534 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14535 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14536 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14537 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14538
14539 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14540 begins with ~.
14541
14542 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14543 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14544
14545 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14546 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14547
14548 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14549 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14550
14551 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14552 character code conversion as well as other things.
14553
14554 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14555 (formerly it did not).
14556
14557 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14558 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14559
14560 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14561 instead of constant strings.
14562
14563 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14564 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14565 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14566
14567 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14568 in the same way as before.
14569
14570 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14571 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14572 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14573
14574 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14575 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14576 else, and returns nil.
14577
14578 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14579 directory cannot be listed.
14580
14581 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14582
14583 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14584 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14585 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14586 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14587 ways:
14588
14589 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14590 It is available through the history command M-n.
14591
14592 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14593 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14594 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14595 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14596 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14597
14598 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14599 argument in this way.
14600
14601 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14602 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14603 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14604
14605 ** Echo area features
14606
14607 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14608 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14609 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14610 after the echo area is cleared.
14611
14612 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14613 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14614
14615 ** Keyboard input features
14616
14617 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14618 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14619
14620 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14621 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14622 by keyboard macros.
14623
14624 ** Frame-related changes
14625
14626 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14627 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14628 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14629
14630 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14631 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14632 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14633
14634 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14635 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14636 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14637 in the selected frame.
14638
14639 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14640 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14641 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14642
14643 ** X Windows features
14644
14645 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14646 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14647 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14648
14649 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14650 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14651
14652 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14653 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14654 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14655
14656 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14657 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14658
14659 ** Subprocess features
14660
14661 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14662 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14663 automatically.
14664
14665 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14666 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14667
14668 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14669 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14670
14671 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14672 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14673
14674 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14675 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14676 goes after the other menu items.
14677
14678 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14679 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14680 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14681 are in use.
14682
14683 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14684 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14685
14686 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14687 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14688 form.
14689
14690 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14691 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14692 but its hook is still run.
14693
14694 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14695 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14696
14697 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14698 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14699 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14700
14701 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14702 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14703 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14704 warned.
14705
14706 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14707 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14708
14709 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14710 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14711 functions like display-time.
14712
14713 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14714 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14715
14716 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14717 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14718 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14719
14720 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14721 if there is an error in compilation.
14722
14723 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14724 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14725 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14726 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14727
14728 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14729 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14730 the *scratch* buffer.
14731
14732 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14733 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14734 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14735 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14736
14737 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14738 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14739 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14740
14741 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14742 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14743 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14744 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14745
14746 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14747 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14748 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14749
14750 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14751 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14752 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14753 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14754 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14755 files at all.
14756
14757 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14758 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14759 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14760 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14761
14762 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14763 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14764 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14765 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14766
14767 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14768
14769 ** imenu.el changes.
14770
14771 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14772 item from menu created by imenu.
14773
14774 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14775 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14776 select one of those items.
14777 \f
14778 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14779
14780 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14781 Copyright information:
14782
14783 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14784 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14785
14786 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14787 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14788 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14789 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14790
14791 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14792 of this document, or of portions of it,
14793 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14794 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14795 \f
14796 Local variables:
14797 mode: outline
14798 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14799 end:
14800
14801 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793